User Guide Stellarium Software PDF
User Guide Stellarium Software PDF
User Guide Stellarium Software PDF
1 User Guide
Georg Zotti, Alexander Wolf (editors)
2019
Copyright
c 2014-2019 Georg Zotti.
Copyright
c 2011-2019 Alexander Wolf.
Copyright
c 2006-2013 Matthew Gates.
Copyright
2013-2014 Barry Gerdes († 2014).
c
STELLARIUM . ORG
Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document under the terms
of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or any later version published by
the Free Software Foundation; with no Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no
Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the appendix G entitled “GNU Free
Documentation License”.
All trademarks, third party brands, product names, trade names, corporate names and company
names mentioned may be trademarks of their respective owners or registered trademarks of other
companies and are used for purposes of explanation and to the readers’ benefit, without implying a
violation of copyright law.
I Basic Use
1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
1.1 Historical notes 3
2 Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
2.1 System Requirements 7
2.1.1 Minimum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
2.1.2 Recommended . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
2.2 Downloading 8
2.3 Installation 8
2.3.1 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
2.3.2 OS X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
2.3.3 Linux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8
2.4 Running Stellarium 9
2.4.1 Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2.4.2 OS X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2.4.3 Linux . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9
2.5 Troubleshooting 9
3 A First Tour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
3.1 Time Travel 12
3.2 Moving Around the Sky 13
3.3 The Main Tool Bar 14
3.4 Taking Screenshots 17
3.5 Bookmarks 17
3.6 Custom Markers 17
7 Landscapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
7.1 Stellarium Landscapes 59
7.1.1 Location information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60
7.1.2 Polygonal landscape . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61
7.1.3 Spherical landscape . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
7.1.4 High resolution (“Old Style”) landscape . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63
7.1.5 Fisheye landscape . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67
7.1.6 Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
7.1.7 Gazetteer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
7.1.8 Packing and Publishing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
7.2 Creating Panorama Photographs for Stellarium 70
7.2.1 Panorama Photography . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70
7.2.2 Hugin Panorama Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
7.2.3 Regular creation of panoramas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72
7.3 Panorama Postprocessing 75
7.3.1 The GIMP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
7.3.2 ImageMagick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
7.3.3 Final Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
7.3.4 Artificial Panoramas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
7.3.5 Nightscape Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
7.4 Other recommended software 81
7.4.1 IrfanView . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
7.4.2 FSPViewer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
7.4.3 Clink . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
7.4.4 Cygwin . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
7.4.5 GNUWin32 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82
8 Deep-Sky Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
8.1 Stellarium DSO Catalog 83
8.1.1 Modifying catalog.dat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84
8.1.2 Modifying names.dat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
8.1.3 Modifying textures.json . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
8.1.4 Modifying outlines.dat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88
8.2 Adding Extra Nebulae Images 89
8.2.1 Preparing a photo for inclusion to the textures.json file . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
8.2.2 Plate Solving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
8.2.3 Processing into a textures.json insert . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
10 Surveys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
10.1 Introduction 99
10.2 Hipslist file and default surveys 99
10.3 Solar system HiPS survey 100
10.4 Digitized Sky Survey 2 (TOAST Survey) 100
10.4.1 Local Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100
III Extending Stellarium
11 Plugins: An Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
11.1 Enabling plugins 105
11.2 Data for plugins 105
16 Scripting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
16.1 Introduction 191
16.2 Script Console 192
16.3 Includes 192
16.4 Minimal Scripts 192
16.5 Example: Retrograde motion of Mars 192
16.5.1 Script header . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192
16.5.2 A body of script . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 193
16.6 More Examples 195
IV Practical Astronomy
17 Astronomical Concepts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
17.1 The Celestial Sphere 199
17.2 Coordinate Systems 200
17.2.1 Altitude/Azimuth Coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
17.2.2 Right Ascension/Declination Coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
17.2.3 Ecliptical Coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
17.2.4 Galactic Coordinates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
17.3 Distance 204
17.4 Time 204
17.4.1 Sidereal Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
17.4.2 Julian Day Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
17.4.3 Delta T . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 206
17.5 Angles 209
17.5.1 Notation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209
17.5.2 Handy Angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
17.6 The Magnitude Scale 210
17.7 Luminosity 211
17.8 Precession 211
17.9 Parallax 213
17.9.1 Geocentric and Topocentric Observations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
17.9.2 Stellar Parallax . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 213
17.10 Proper Motion 214
20 Exercises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
20.1 Find M31 in Binoculars 247
20.1.1 Simulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
20.1.2 For Real . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
20.2 Handy Angles 247
20.3 Find a Lunar Eclipse 248
20.4 Find a Solar Eclipse 248
20.5 Find a retrograde motion of Mars 248
20.6 Analemma 248
20.7 Transit of Venus 249
20.8 Transit of Mercury 249
20.9 Triple shadows on Jupiter 249
20.10 Jupiter without satellites 249
20.11 Mutual occultations of planets 249
20.12 The proper motion of stars 250
V Appendices
A Default Hotkeys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 253
A.1 Mouse actions with combination of the keyboard keys 253
A.2 Display Options 253
A.3 Miscellaneous 255
A.4 Movement and Selection 256
A.5 Date and Time 256
A.6 Scripts 257
A.7 Windows 257
A.8 Plugins 257
A.8.1 Angle Measure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
A.8.2 ArchaeoLines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
A.8.3 Equation of Time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 257
A.8.4 Exoplanets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
A.8.5 Field of View . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
A.8.6 Meteor Showers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
A.8.7 Oculars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
A.8.8 Pulsars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 258
A.8.9 Quasars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
A.8.10 Satellites . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
A.8.11 Scenery3d: 3D landscapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
A.8.12 Solar System Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
A.8.13 Telescope Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 259
A.8.14 Text User Interface (TUI) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 260
F Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
F.1 Date Range 319
F.2 Stellar Proper Motion 319
F.3 Planetary Positions 320
F.4 Minor Bodies 321
F.5 Precession and Nutation 321
F.6 Planet Axes 321
F.7 Eclipses 321
F.8 The Calendar 321
G GNU Free Documentation License . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 323
G.1 PREAMBLE 323
G.2 APPLICABILITY AND DEFINITIONS 323
G.3 VERBATIM COPYING 325
G.4 COPYING IN QUANTITY 325
G.5 MODIFICATIONS 325
G.6 COMBINING DOCUMENTS 327
G.7 COLLECTIONS OF DOCUMENTS 327
G.8 AGGREGATION WITH INDEPENDENT WORKS 327
G.9 TRANSLATION 328
G.10 TERMINATION 328
G.11 FUTURE REVISIONS OF THIS LICENSE 328
G.12 RELICENSING 328
H Acknowledgements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
H.1 Contributors 331
H.2 How you can help 331
H.3 Technical Articles 332
H.4 Included Source Code 333
H.5 Data 333
H.6 Image Credits 335
H.6.1 Full credits for “earthmap” texture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 337
H.6.2 License for the JPL planets images . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 338
H.6.3 DSS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 339
Bibliography . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
I
Basic Use
1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3
1.1 Historical notes
2 Getting Started . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7
2.1 System Requirements
2.2 Downloading
2.3 Installation
2.4 Running Stellarium
2.5 Troubleshooting
3 A First Tour . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
3.1 Time Travel
3.2 Moving Around the Sky
3.3 The Main Tool Bar
3.4 Taking Screenshots
3.5 Bookmarks
3.6 Custom Markers
Stellarium is a software project that allows people to use their home computer as a virtual plan-
etarium. It calculates the positions of the Sun and Moon, planets and stars, and draws how the
sky would look to an observer depending on their location and the time. It can also draw the
constellations and simulate astronomical phenomena such as meteor showers or comets, and solar
or lunar eclipses.
Stellarium may be used as an educational tool for teaching about the night sky, as an ob-
servational aid for amateur astronomers wishing to plan a night’s observing or even drive their
telescopes to observing targets, or simply as a curiosity (it’s fun!). Because of the high quality
of the graphics that Stellarium produces, it is used in some real planetarium projector products
and museum projection setups. Some amateur astronomy groups use it to create sky maps for
describing regions of the sky in articles for newsletters and magazines, and the exchangeable sky
cultures feature invites its use in the field of Cultural Astronomy research and outreach.
Stellarium is still under development, and by the time you read this guide, a newer version may
have been released with even more features than those documented here. Check for updates to
Stellarium at the Stellarium website1 .
If you have questions and/or comments about this guide, or about Stellarium itself, visit the
Stellarium site at Github2 or our Google Groups forum3 .
1 http://stellarium.org
2 https://github.com/Stellarium/stellarium
3 https://groups.google.com/forum/#!forum/stellarium
4 Chapter 1. Introduction
A detailed track of development can be found in the ChangeLog file in the installation folder. A
few important milestones for the project:
2000 first lines of code for the project
2001-06 first public mention (and users feedbacks!) of the software on the French newsgroup
fr.sci.astronomie.amateur 4
2003-01 Stellarium reviewed by Astronomy magazine
2003-07 funding for developing planetarium features (fisheye projection and other features)
2005-12 use accurate (and fast) planetary model
2006-05 Stellarium “Project Of the Month” on SourceForge
2006-08 large stars catalogs
2007-01 funding by ESO for development of professional astronomy extensions (VirGO)
2007-04 developers’ meeting near Munich, Germany
2007-05 switch to the Qt library as main GUI and general purpose library
2009-09 plugin system, enabling a lot of new development
2010-07 Stellarium ported on Maemo mobile device
2010-11 artificial satellites plugin
2014-06 high quality satellites and Saturn rings shadows, normal mapping for moon craters
2014-07 v0.13.0: adapt to OpenGL evolutions in the Qt framework, now requires more modern
4 https://groups.google.com/d/topic/fr.sci.astronomie.amateur/OT7K8yogRlI/
discussion
1.1 Historical notes 5
2.1.1 Minimum
• Linux/Unix; Windows 7 and later; Mac OS X 10.10.0 and later
• 3D graphics capabilities which support OpenGL 3.0 and GLSL 1.3 (2008 GeForce 8xxx and
later, ATI/AMD Radeon HD-2xxx and later; Intel HD graphics (Core-i 2xxx and later)) or
OpenGL ES 2.0 and GLSL ES 1.0 (e.g., ARM SBCs like Raspberry Pi 2/3). On Windows,
some older cards may be supported via ANGLE when they support DirectX10.
• 512 MB RAM
• 250 MB free on disk
2.1.2 Recommended
• Linux/Unix; Windows 7 and later; Mac OS X 10.10.0 and later
• 3D graphics card which supports OpenGL 3.3 and above and GLSL1.3 and later
• 1 GB RAM or more
• 1.5 GB free on disk (About 3GB extra required for the optional DE430/DE431 files).
• A dark room for realistic rendering — details like the Milky Way, Zodiacal Light or star
twinkling can’t be seen in a bright room.
1 Asof autumn 2017, you need to enable the experimental OpenGL driver and compile the drm and
Mesa 17 libraries from sources. See 2.3.3
8 Chapter 2. Getting Started
2.2 Downloading
Download the correct package for your operating system directly from the main page,
http://stellarium.org. An archive of all available versions is available at https://sourceforge.
net/projects/stellarium/files/.
2.3 Installation
2.3.1 Windows
1. Double click on the installer file you downloaded:
• stellarium-0.19.1-win64.exe for 64-bit Windows 7 and later.
• stellarium-0.19.1-win32.exe for 32-bit Windows 7 and later.
2. Follow the on-screen instructions.
2.3.2 OS X
1. Locate the Stellarium-0.19.1.dmg file in Finder and double click on it or open it using
the Disk Utility application. Now, a new disk appears on your desktop and Stellarium is in it.
2. Open the new disk and please take a moment to read the ReadMe file. Then drag Stellarium
to the Applications folder.
3. Note: You should copy Stellarium to the Applications folder before running it — some users
have reported problems running it directly from the disk image (.dmg).
2.3.3 Linux
Check if your distribution has a package for Stellarium already — if so you’re probably best off
using it. If not, you can download and build the source.
For Ubuntu we provide a package repository with the latest stable releases. Open a terminal
and type:
sudo add - apt - repository ppa : stellarium / stellarium - releases
sudo apt - get update
sudo apt - get install stellarium
Raspberry Pi 2/3
These tiny ARM-based computers are very popular for small and energy-efficient applications like
controlling push-to Dobsonians. A new open-source OpenGL driver stack has been made available
recently, but as of October 2017 the default Raspbian operating system comes with an outdated
version. Stellarium requires Mesa 17 or later. To set up a Raspberry Pi 2 or 3 with Raspbian
Stretch for use with Stellarium, activate the OpenGL driver in raspi-config and follow instructions
from the VC4 wiki.2 The libdrm upgrade is required and does not harm, but you can also install
Mesa 17 in addition to the stock Mesa 13 following another set of instructions.3
For Ubuntu 16.04 LTS, follow instructions4 .
Note that as of October 2017 (Mesa 17.4) the 3D planets do not work.
2 https://github.com/anholt/mesa/wiki/VC4-complete-Raspbian-upgrade. You only need
to follow the instructions on first boot, libdrm and Mesa.
3 https://github.com/anholt/mesa/wiki/Building-Mesa-for-VC4. Note that you may
need to add a symbolic link to the VC4 library. With all paths from these instructions,
ln -s ~/prefix/dri/vc4_dri.so ~/prefix/vc4_dri.so should do the trick.
4 https://ubuntu-mate.community/t/tutorial-activate-opengl-driver-for-ubuntu-mate-16-04/
7094
2.4 Running Stellarium 9
2.4.2 OS X
Double click on the Stellarium application. Add it to your Dock for quick access.
2.4.3 Linux
If your distribution had a package you’ll probably already have an item in the GNOME or KDE
application menus. If not, just open a terminal and type stellarium.
2.5 Troubleshooting
Stellarium writes startup and other diagnostic messages into a logfile. Please see section 5.3 where
this file is located on your system. This file is essential in case when you feel you need to report a
problem with your system which has not been found before.
If you don’t succeed in running Stellarium, please see the online forum5 . It includes FAQ
(Frequently Asked Questions, also Frequently Answered Questions) and a general question section
which may include further hints. Please make sure you have read and understood the FAQ before
asking the same questions again.
5 https://github.com/Stellarium/stellarium
3. A First Tour
Figure 3.1: Stellarium main view. (Combination of day and night views.)
When Stellarium first starts, we see a green meadow under a sky. Depending on the time of day, it
is either a day or night scene. If you are connected to the Internet, an automatic lookup will attempt
to detect your approximate position.1
1 See section 4.2 if you want to switch this off.
12 Chapter 3. A First Tour
At the bottom left of the screen, you can see the status bar. This shows the current observer
location, vertical field of view (FOV), graphics performance in frames per second (FPS) and the
current simulation date and time. If you move the mouse over the status bar, it will move up to
reveal a tool bar which gives quick control over the program.
The rest of the view is devoted to rendering a realistic scene including a panoramic landscape
and the sky. If the simulation time and observer location are such that it is night time, you will see
stars, planets and the moon in the sky, all in the correct positions.
You can drag with the mouse on the sky to look around or use the cursor keys. You can zoom
with the mouse wheel or the Page or Page keys.
Much of Stellarium can be controlled very intuitively with the mouse. Many settings can
additionally be switched with shortcut keys (hotkeys). Advanced users will learn to use these
shortcut keys. Sometimes a key combination will be used. For example, you can quit Stellarium by
pressing Ctrl + Q on Windows and Linux, and + Q on Mac OS X. For simplicity, we will
show only the Windows/Linux version. We will present the default hotkeys in this guide. However,
almost all hotkeys can be reconfigured to match your taste. Note that some listed shortkeys are only
available as key combinations on international keyboard layouts, e.g., keys which require pressing
AltGr on a German keyboard. These must be reconfigured, please see 4.8 for details.
The way Stellarium is shown on the screen is primarily governed by the menus. These are
accessed by dragging the mouse to the left or bottom edge of the screen, where the menus will slide
out. In case you want to see the menu bars permanently, you can press the small buttons right in the
lower left corner to keep them visible.
OK, so lets go see the future! Click the mouse once on the increase time speed button .
Not a whole lot seems to happen. However, take a look at the clock in the status bar. You should
see the time going by faster than a normal clock! Click the button a second time. Now the time is
going by faster than before. If it’s night time, you might also notice that the stars have started to
3.2 Moving Around the Sky 13
move slightly across the sky. If it’s daytime you might be able to see the sun moving (but it’s less
apparent than the movement of the stars). Increase the rate at which time passes again by clicking
on the button a third time. Now time is really flying!
Let time move on at this fast speed for a little while. Notice how the stars move across the sky.
If you wait a little while, you’ll see the Sun rising and setting. It’s a bit like a time-lapse movie.
Stellarium not only allows for moving forward through time – you can go backwards too! Click
on the real time speed button . The stars and/or the Sun should stop scooting across the sky.
Now press the decrease time speed button once. Look at the clock. Time has stopped. Click
the decrease time speed button four or five more times. Now we’re falling back through time at
quite a rate (about one day every ten seconds!).
Key Description
Cursor keys Pan the view left, right, up and down
Page / Page , Ctrl + / Ctrl + Zoom in and out
Left mouse button Select an object in the sky
Right mouse button Clear selected object
Centre mouse button (wheel press) Centre selected object and start tracking
Mouse wheel Zoom in and out
Centre view on selected object
Forward-slash ( / ) Auto-zoom in to selected object
Backslash ( \ ) Auto-zoom out to original field of view
As well as travelling through time, Stellarium lets to look around the sky freely, and zoom in
and out. There are several ways to accomplish this listed in table 3.2.
Let’s try it. Use the cursors to move around left, right, up and down. Zoom in a little using
the Page key, and back out again using the Page . Press the \ key and see how Stellarium
returns to the original field of view (how “zoomed in” the view is), and direction of view.
It’s also possible to move around using the mouse. If you left-click and drag somewhere on the
sky, you can pull the view around.
Another method of moving is to select some object in the sky (left-click on the object), and
press the Space key to centre the view on that object. Similarly, selecting an object and pressing
the forward-slash key / will centre on the object and zoom right in on it.
14 Chapter 3. A First Tour
The forward-slash / and backslash \ keys auto-zoom in an out to different zoom levels
depending on what is selected. If the object selected is a planet or moon in a sub-system with a lot of
moons (e.g. Jupiter), the initial zoom in will go to an intermediate level where the whole sub-system
should be visible. A second zoom will go to the full zoom level on the selected object. Similarly, if
you are fully zoomed in on a moon of Jupiter, the first auto-zoom out will go to the sub-system
zoom level. Subsequent auto-zoom out will fully zoom out and return the initial direction of view.
For objects that are not part of a sub-system, the initial auto-zoom in will zoom right in on the
selected object (the exact field of view depending on the size/type of the selected object), and the
initial auto-zoom out will return to the initial FOV and direction of view.
Stellarium can do a whole lot more than just draw the stars. Figure 3.2 shows some of
Stellarium’s visual effects including constellation line and boundary drawing, constellation art,
planet hints, and atmospheric halo around the bright Moon. The controls in the main tool bar
provide a mechanism for turning on and off the visual effects.
When the mouse if moved to the bottom left of the screen, a second tool bar becomes visible.
All the buttons in this side tool bar open and close dialog boxes which contain controls for further
configuration of the program. The dialogs will be described in the next chapter.
Table 3.3 describes the operations of buttons on the main tool bar and the side tool bar, and
gives their default keyboard shortcuts.
3.3 The Main Tool Bar 15
Flip view (horizontal) Ctrl + Shift + H Flip the image in the horizontal
plane. 1
Flip view (vertical) Ctrl + Shift + V Flip the image in the vertical plane.
1
3.5 Bookmarks
You can store your favourite objects or views with a bookmark. Press Alt + B or . If date
and/or location are relevant, make sure you activate the respective buttons.
Actions Description
Shift & left click Add custom marker
Shift & right click Delete the one closest marker to mouse cursor
Alt + Shift & right click Delete all custom markers
4. The User Interface
This chapter describes the dialog windows which can be accessed from the left menu bar.
Most of Stellarium’s settings can be changed using the view window (press or F4 ) and
the configuration window ( or F2 ). Most settings have short labels. To learn more about
some settings, more information is available as tooltips, small text boxes which appear when you
hover the mouse cursor over a button.1
You can drag the windows around, and the position will be used again when you restart v0.15
Stellarium. If this would mean the window is off-screen (because you start in windowed mode, or
with a different screen), the window will be moved so that at least a part is visible.
Some options are really rarely changed and therefore may only be configured by editing the
configuration file. See 5.4 The Main Configuration File for more details.
In addition to the time rate control buttons on the main toolbar, you can use the date and time
window (open with the button or F5 ) to set the simulation time. The values for year, month,
1 Unfortunately, on Windows 7 and later, with some NVidia and AMD GPUs in OpenGL mode, these
tooltips often do not work.
20 Chapter 4. The User Interface
day, hour, minutes and seconds may be modified by typing new values, by clicking the up and down
arrows above and below the values, and by using the mouse wheel.
The other tab in this window allows you to see or set Julian Day and/or Modified Julian Day
numbers (see 17.4.2).
The positions of the stars in the sky is dependent on your location on Earth (or other planet) as well
as the time and date. For Stellarium to show accurately what is (or will be/was) in the sky, you
must tell it where you are. You only need to do this once – Stellarium can save your location so
you won’t need to set it again until you move.
v0.13.1 After installation, Stellarium uses an online service which tries to find your approximate
location based on the IP address you are using. This seems very practical, but if you feel this causes
privacy issues, you may want to switch this feature off. You should also consider switching it off
on a computer which does not move, to save network bandwidth.
To set your location more accurately, or if the lookup service fails, press F6 to open the
location window (Fig. 4.2). There are a few ways you can set your location:
1. Just click on the map.
2. Search for a city where you live using the search edit box at the top right of the window, and
select the right city from the list.
3. Click on the map to filter the list of cities in the vicinity of your click, then choose from the
shortlist.
4. Enter a new location using the longitude, latitude and other data.
v0.16/0.18.1 5. Click on Get Location from GPS if you have a GPS receiver. You activate a periodic request for
GPS fixes. After a few seconds, the button should change color and give a textual feedback.
Green indicates a good position, yellow indicates a 2D-fix only, which means altitudes are
not available. (Leave the GPS device running for a few minutes and/or search a place with
better sky view.) You could leave it running if you are operating a fast-moving observatory
platform, but rather switch it off when you see a good fix, so that other programs can use the
4.3 The Configuration Window 21
serial GPS connection. Red signals an error, and further positions are not retrieved but the
button is reset. You may press the button again to start over.
Sometimes you have to try several times or let it run for a while to get a green button
indicating a valid 3D fix including altitude. See section 5.5.4 for configuration details.
If you want to use the current location permanently, click on the “use as default” checkbox, disable
“Get location from Network”, and close the location window.
• The information displays in various colours depending on the type and level of the stored
data
The Extras tab (Fig. 4.5) allows you to customize information displayed about a selected object,
download more star catalogs and also allows to hide or show additional buttons in the lower button
bar.
Show nightmode button You can toggle display of the nightmode button.
Show nebula background button You can toggle display of DSO photographs with this button.
Show flip buttons When enabled, two buttons will be added to the main tool bar which allow
the main view to be mirrored in the vertical and horizontal directions. This is useful when
observing through telecopes which may cause the image to be mirrored.
Show DSS button You can toggle display of Digitized Sky Survey with this button (see sec-
tion 10.4).
Show HiPS button You can toggle display of Hierarchical Progressive Surveys with this button
(see section 4.4.7).
Show bookmarks button You can enable display of Bookmarks dialog with this button.
Show fullscreen button You can toggle display of the fullscreen button.
Show Quit button You can toggle display of the button to quit Stellarium.
Use buttons background Applies a gray background under the buttons on the bottom bar.
The Time tab (Fig. 4.6) allows to specify what simulation time should be used when the
program starts:
System date and time Stellarium will start with the simulation time equal to the operating system
clock.
System date at Stellarium will start with the same date as the operating system clock, but the
time will be fixed at the specified value. This is a useful setting for those people who use
Stellarium during the day to plan observing sessions for the upcoming evening.
Other some fixed time can be chosen which will be used every time Stellarium starts.
4.3 The Configuration Window 25
The middle field allows specify display formats for date and time on bottom toolbar:
JD Stellarium will display Julian Days (JD).
Date and time Stellarium will display date and time in selected format.
The lowest field allows selection of the correction model for the time correction ∆T (see sec-
tion 17.4.3). Default is “Espenak and Meeus (2006)”. Please use other values only if you know
what you are doing.
The Tools tab (Fig. 4.7) contains planetarium options (like enabling/disabling of keyboard
shortcuts for panning and zooming the main view) and options for screenshots.
Spheric mirror distortion This option pre-warps the main view such that it may be projected
onto a spherical mirror using a projector. The resulting image will be reflected up from the
spherical mirror in such a way that it may shine onto a small planetarium dome (or even just
the ceiling of your dining room), making a cheap planetarium projection system.
Disc viewport This option masks the main view producing the effect of a telescope eyepiece. It is
also useful when projecting Stellarium’s output with a fish-eye lens planetarium projector.
Gravity labels This option makes labels of objects in the main view align with the nearest horizon.
This means that labels projected onto a dome are always aligned properly.
Select single constellation When active, clicking on a star that is member in the constellation
lines will make the constellation stand out. See section 4.4.6 for details.
Auto-enabling for the atmosphere When changing planet during location change, atmosphere
will be switched as required.
Dithering options to allow select better simulation of sky on different hardware.
Auto zoom out returns to initial direction of view When enabled, this option changes the be-
haviour of the zoom out key \ so that it resets the initial direction of view in addition to
26 Chapter 4. The User Interface
Screenshots
v0.18.1 You can set the directory where screenshots will be stored, and also whether you want screenshots
sized like Stellarium’s window or some other, likely larger size. The maximum possible size
depends on your hardware. 4096 × 4096 should be possible on most PCs, others may even create
16384 × 16384 images. The vertical field of view will be the same as in the current view.
v0.19.0 You can also set the file format. The exact selection depends on platform and version of the
underlying Qt framework. Notable formats are PNG (lossless), JPG (lossy), JPEG (higher quality
JPG), BMP (Windows Bitmap), WEBP, TIF (LZW compressed), TIFF (uncompressed), PBM,
PGM, PPM, XBM, XPM, and ICO (thumbnails).
Scripts that use sound or embedded videos will need a version of Stellarium configured at
compile time with multimedia support enabled. It must be pointed out here that sound or video
codecs available depends on the sound and video capabilities of you computer platform and may
not work.
Absolute scale is the size of stars as rendered by Stellarium. If you increase this value, all stars
will appear larger than before.
Relative scale determines the difference in size of bright stars compared to faint stars. Values
higher than 1.00 will make the brightest stars appear much larger than they do in the sky.
This is useful for creating star charts, or when learning the basic constellations.
Twinkle controls how much the stars twinkle when atmosphere is enabled (scintillation, see
section 18.13.2). Since v0.15.0, the twinkling is reduced in higher altitudes, where the star
light passes the atmosphere in a steeper angle and is less distorted.
Limit magnitude Inhibits automatic addition of fainter stars when zooming in. This may be
helpful if you are interested in naked eye stars only.
Labels and markers you can independantly change the amount of labels displayed for stars. The
further to the right the sliders are set, the more labels you will see. Note that more labels
will also appear as you zoom in.
Projection field: Selecting items in this list changes the projection method which Stellarium
uses to draw the sky (Snyder, 1987). Options are:
Perspective Perspective projection maps the horizon and other great circles like equator, ecliptic,
hour lines, etc. into straight lines. The maximum field of view is 150◦ . The mathematical
name for this projection method is gnomonic projection.
Stereographic Stereographic projection has been known since antiquity and was originally known
as the planisphere projection. It preserves the angles at which curves cross each other but it
does not preserve area. Else it is similar to fish-eye projection mode. The maximum field of
view in this mode is 235◦ .
Fish-Eye Stellarium draws the sky using azimuthal equidistant projection. In fish-eye projection,
straight lines become curves when they appear a large angular distance from the centre of
the field of view (like the distortions seen with very wide angle camera lenses). This is more
pronounced as the user zooms out. The maximum field of view in this mode is 180◦ .
Orthographic Orthographic projection is related to perspective projection, but the point of per-
spective is set to an infinite distance. The maximum field of view is 180◦ .
Equal Area The full name of this projection method is Lambert azimuthal equal-area projection.
It preserves the area but not the angle. The maximum field of view is 360◦ .
Hammer-Aitoff The Hammer projection is an equal-area map projection, described by E RNST
VON H AMMER (1858–1925) in 1892 and directly inspired by the Aitoff projection. The
maximum field of view in this mode is 360◦ .
Sinusoidal The sinusoidal projection is a pseudocylindrical equal-area map projection, sometimes
called the Sanson–Flamsteed or the Mercator equal-area projection. Meridians are mapped
to sine curves.
Mercator Mercator projection is a cylindrical projection developed by G ERARDUS M ERCATOR
(1512–1594) which preserves the angles between objects, and the scale around an object is
the same in all directions. The poles are mapped to infinity. The maximum field of view in
this mode is 233◦ .
Miller cylindrical The Miller cylindrical projection is a modified Mercator projection, proposed
by O SBORN M AITLAND M ILLER (1897–1979) in 1942. The poles are no longer mapped to
infinity.
Cylinder The full name of this simple projection mode is cylindrical equidistant projection or
Plate Carrée. The maximum field of view in this mode is 233◦ .
30 Chapter 4. The User Interface
Solar System objects this group of options lets you turn on and off various features related to
the planets. Simulation of light speed will give more precise positions for planetary bodies
which move rapidly against backround stars (e.g. the moons of Jupiter). The Scale Moon
option will increase the apparent size of the moon in the sky, which can be nice for wide
field of view shots.
Labels and markers you can independantly change the amount of labels displayed for Solar
system objects. The further to the right the sliders are set, the more labels you will see. Note
that more labels will also appear as you zoom in.
Shooting stars Stellarium has a simple meteor simulation option. This setting controls how many
shooting stars will be shown. Note that shooting stars are only visible when the time rate is 1,
and might not be visiable at some times of day. Meteor showers are not currently simulated.
Atmosphere settings
An auxiliary dialog contains detail settings for the atmosphere. Here you can set atmospheric
pressure and temperature which influence refraction (see section 18.13.2), and the opacity factor kv
for extinction, magnitude loss per airmass (see section 18.13.1).
The Markings tab of the View window (Fig. 4.13) controls plot various grids and lines on
celestial sphere.
Show ground This turns on and off landscape rendering (same as the button in the main
tool-bar).
Show_fog This turns on and off rendering of a band of fog/haze along the horizon, when available
in this landscape.
Use associated planet and position When enabled, selecting a new landscape will automatically
update the observer location.
Use this landscape as default Selecting this option will save the landscape into the program
configuration file so that the current landscape will be the one used when Stellarium starts.
Minimal brightness Use some minimal brightness setting. Moonless night on very dark locations
may appear too dark on your screen. You may want to configure some minimal brightness
here.
from landscape, if given Landscape authors may decide to provide such a minimal brightness
value in the landscape.ini file.
Show landscape labels Landscapes can be configured with a gazetteer of interesting points, e.g.,
mountain peaks, which can be labeled with this option.
Show illumination to reflect the ugly developments of our civilisation, landscapes can be config-
ured with a layer of light pollution, e.g., streetlamps, bright windows, or the sky glow of a
nearby city. This layer, if present, will be mixed in when it is dark enough.
Using the button Add/remove landscapes. . . , you can also install new landscapes from ZIP files
which you can download e.g. from the Stellarium website2 or create yourself (see ch. 7 Landscapes),
or remove these custom landscapes.
v0.15.2 Loading large landscapes may take several seconds. If you like to switch rapidly between
several landscapes and have enough memory, you can increase the default cache size to keep more
landscapes loaded previously available in memory. Note that a large landscape can take up 200MB
or more! See section D.1.11.
4.4 The View Settings Window 33
If you explain a skyculture where constellations also have borders defined, a click anywhere in
the constellation area is enough. For other skycultures, clicking onto a star which is not member of
a constellation line will display all constellations.
Press W to remove all but the last selected constellation. If you had deleted selection (right
mouse click) before pressing W , all constellations are hidden. Press W again to also hide the
single displayed one, or click another star to select the next constellation. If you need to keep the
single constellation visible, select the currently selected star again to select it again. Press Alt + W
to show all constellations.
With a little training, you will be able to give inspiring constellation tours.
v0.18.0 The Surveys tab (Fig. 4.16) allows to toggle the visibility of online sky or solar system surveys
(see chapter 10 for description of the surveys format). Currently, only HiPS surveys are supported.
On the left side of the window we see the list of available surveys from the configured sources
(See section D.1.27 for how to change the default sources). On the right side a description of the
selected survey and its properties are displayed.
Surveys are grouped by types. The top combobox allows to filter the listed surveys according
to a given type (Deep Sky or Solar System).
You can toggle the visibility of a survey by checking the box on the left of the survey name
in the list. (Note that as of v0.18.0, only a single deep sky survey can be rendered at a time, so it
makes no sense to select more than one in the list!) Once a survey is visible you should be able to
see its loading status in the loading bar area of the sky view.
Deep sky surveys will be rendered aligned with the sky view, while solar system surveys
automatically map on the proper body.
As you type, Stellarium will make a list of objects which contains what you have typed so far.
The first of the list of matching objects will be highlighted. If you press the key, the selection
will change to the next item in the list. Hitting the key will go to the currently highlighted
object and close the search dialog.
For example, suppose we want to locate Saturn’s moon Mimas. Type the first letter of the name,
m, to see a list of objects whose name contains m: Haumea, Miranda, Umbriel, . . .
You may want at this point to have Stellarium rather propose object names with start with the
string you enter. Do that in the Options tab of this panel. Now repeat searching (delete, and re-enter
m to start over). Now the list is shorter and contains only objects which start with m: Maia, Mars,
. . . The first item in this list, Maia, is highlighted. Pressing now would go to Maia, but we
want Mimas. We can either press a few times to highlight Mimas and then hit , or we can
continue to type the name until it is the first/only object in the list.
The Position tab (Fig. 4.18) provides a convenient way to enter a set of coordinates.
The List Search tab (Fig. 4.20) allows selection of an object from predefined sets. The number
of choices is governed by the loaded DSO catalogs and plug-ins. Scroll down the first window to
select the type. Click on the name and Stellarium will go to that object.
The Options tab (Fig. 4.20) provides a few settings to fine-tune your search experience. When
the name of an object to find is typed in the object window and you are connected to the internet and
“Extend search” is ticked, Stellarium will search the SIMBAD on-line data bases for its coordinates.
36 Chapter 4. The User Interface
You can then click the button or press return. Stellarium will point you at that object in the sky
even if there is no object displayed on the screen. The SIMBAD server being used can be selected
from the scroll window.
You can call it by pressing F10 or the button on the left menu bar. The Astronomical
Calculations window shows six tabs with different functionality.
v0.18.3 In version 0.18.3 we added exporting the data to XLSX files in addition to CSV files.
Two columns in the table may be helpful for planning observation of phenomena: v0.18.2/.3
solar elongation angular distance from the Sun
lunar elongation angular distance from the Moon
Optional graphs for the Sun (with lines for civil, nautical and astronomical twilight) and the
Moon (dashed) are also available.
40 Chapter 4. The User Interface
v0.18.0 This subtab can show a “Monthly Elevation” graph for the current year at the selected time.
This tool was introduced for planning yearly observations (Fig. 4.28).
This subtab can show “Angular Distance” graph — change of angular distance between the v0.18.3
Moon and selected object (for example some deep-sky object) for the nearest 30 days. This tool
was introduced for planning monthly observations (Fig. 4.30).
brighter than magnitude spinbox. You may center an object from the right list in the sky map just
by selecting it.
Note that only DSO from catalogs which you have selected in the DSO panel (section 4.4.3)
will be found.
v0.18.3 In version 0.18.3 this tool has been refactored: the tool for searching items from list of Matching
Objects was removed, the filter for magnitudes was moved to the right and we added a new filter
here to limit the range of acceptable angular sizes of matched objects. In addition to the names we
added 5 new sortable columns: magnitude, rising time, transit time, setting time and angular size of
object.
Figure 4.32: Astronomical Calculations (AstroCalc): Planetary Calculator (PC), Data Tab
v0.18.2 In version 0.18.2 we enhanced this tool with a new tab (Graphs), where you may see the change
in the linear and angular distances between selected celestial bodies over a range of 600 days
(centered on the current date) as graphs (Fig. 4.33).
4.7 Help Window 43
The Help Tab lists all of Stellarium’s keystrokes. Note that some features are only available as
keystrokes, so it’s a good idea to have a browse of the information in this window.
You can edit the shortcut keys here. Each available function can be configured with up to
two key combinations. You may want to reconfigure keys for example if you have a non-English
keyboard layout and some keys either do not work at all, or feel unintuitive for you, or if you are
familiar with other software and want to use the same hotkeys for similar functions. Simply select
the function and click with the mouse into the edit field, then press your key of choice. If the key
has been taken already, a message will tell you.
This tool is available through the Help Tab of the Help window (see section 4.7.1) and the
Tools Tab of the Configuration window (see section 4.3.5).
II
Advanced Use
7 Landscapes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
7.1 Stellarium Landscapes
7.2 Creating Panorama Photographs for Stellarium
7.3 Panorama Postprocessing
7.4 Other recommended software
8 Deep-Sky Objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
8.1 Stellarium DSO Catalog
8.2 Adding Extra Nebulae Images
10 Surveys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
10.1 Introduction
10.2 Hipslist file and default surveys
10.3 Solar system HiPS survey
10.4 Digitized Sky Survey 2 (TOAST Survey)
5. Files and Directories
5.1 Directories
Stellarium has many data files containing such things as star catalogue data, nebula images, button
icons, font files and configuration files. When Stellarium looks for a file, it looks in two places.
First, it looks in the user directory for the account which is running Stellarium. If the file is not
found there, Stellarium looks in the installation directory1 . Thus it is possible for Stellarium to be
installed by an administrative user and yet have a writable configuration file for non-administrative
users. Another benefit of this method is on multi-user systems: Stellarium can be installed by
the administrator, and different users can maintain their own configuration and other files in their
personal user accounts.
In addition to the main search path, Stellarium saves some files in other locations, for example
screens shots and recorded scripts.
The locations of the user directory, installation directory, screenshot save directory and script
save directory vary according to the operating system and installation options used. The following
sections describe the locations for various operating systems.
5.1.1 Windows
installation directory By default this is C:\Program Files\Stellarium\, although this can
be adjusted during the installation process.
user directory This is the Stellarium sub-folder in the Application Data folder for the user account
which is used to run Stellarium. Depending on the version of Windows and its configuration,
this could be any of the following (each of these is tried, if it fails, the next in the list if tried).
% APPDATA %\ Stellarium \
% USERPROFILE %\ Stellarium \
% HOMEDRIVE %\% HOMEPATH %\ Stellarium \
% HOME %\ Stellarium \
Stellarium ’ s installation directory
1 The installation directory was referred to as the config root directory in previous versions of this guide
50 Chapter 5. Files and Directories
Thus, on a typical Windows Vista/7/10 system with user “Bob Dobbs”, the user directory
will be:
C :\ Users \ Bob Dobbs \ AppData \ Roaming \ Stellarium \
The user data directory is unfortunately hidden by default. To make it accessible in the Win-
dows file explorer, open an Explorer window and select Organize... Folder and search options .
Make sure folders marked as hidden are now displayed. Also, deselect the checkbox to “hide
known file name endings”.2
screenshot save directory Screenshots will be saved to the Pictures/Stellarium directory,
although this can be changed in the GUI (see section 4.3.5) or with a command line option
(see section 6).
5.1.2 Mac OS X
installation directory This is found inside the application bundle, Stellarium.app. See Inside
Application Bundles3 for more information.
user directory This is the sub-directory Library/Preferences/Stellarium/ (or
~/Library/Application Support/Stellarium on newest versions of Mac OS X) of
the user’s home directory.
screenshot save directory Screenshots are saved to the user’s Desktop.
5.1.3 Linux
installation directory This is in the share/stellarium sub-directory of the installation prefix,
i.e., usually /usr/share/stellarium or /usr/local/share/stellarium/.
user directory This is the .stellarium sub-directory of user’s home directory, i.e., ~/.stellarium/.
This is a hidden folder, so if you are using a graphical file browser, you may want to change
its settings to “display hidden folders”.
screenshot save directory Screenshots are saved to the user’s home directory.
skycultures/ contains constellations, common star names and constellation artwork for Stel-
larium’s many sky cultures. Each culture has its own sub-directory in the skycultures
directory.
nebulae/ contains data and image files for nebula textures. In the future Stellarium may be able
to support multiple sets of nebula images and switch between them at runtime. This feature
is not implemented for version 0.19.1, although the directory structure is in place - each set
of nebula textures has its own sub-directory in the nebulae directory.
stars/ contains Stellarium’s star catalogues. In the future Stellarium may be able to support
multiple star catalogues and switch between them at runtime. This feature is not implemented
for version 0.19.1, although the directory structure is in place – each star catalogue has its
own sub-directory in the stars directory.
data/ contains miscellaneous data files including fonts, solar system data, city locations, etc.
textures/ contains miscellaneous texture files, such as the graphics for the toolbar buttons, planet
texture maps, etc.
ephem/ (optional) may contain data files for planetary ephemerides DE430 and DE431 (see 5.5.3).
If any file exists in both the installation directory and user directory, the version in the user
directory will be used. Thus it is possible to override settings which are part of the main Stellarium
installation by copying the relevant file to the user area and modifying it there.
It is recommended to add new landscapes or sky cultures by creating the relevant files and
directories within the user directory, leaving the installation directory unchanged. In this manner
different users on a multi-user system can customise Stellarium without affecting the other users,
and updating Stellarium will not risk the loss of your own data.
The configuration file is a regular text file, so all you need to edit it is a text editor like Notepad
on Windows, Text Edit on the Mac, or nano/vi/gedit/emacs/leafpad etc. on Linux.
A complete list of configuration file options and values may be found in appendix D.1.
The files can be placed in a folder named ephem inside either the installation directory or the
user directory (see 5.2). Alternatively, if you have them already stored elsewhere, you may add the
path to config.ini like:
[ astro ]
de430_path = C :/ Astrodata / JPL_DE43x / linux_p1550p2650 .430
de431_path = C :/ Astrodata / JPL_DE43x / lnxm13000p17000 .431
For fast access avoid storing them on a network drive or USB pendrive!
You activate use of either ephemeris in the Configuration panel ( F2 ). If you activate both,
preference will be given for DE430 if the simulation time allows it. Outside of the valid times,
VSOP87 will always be used.
Acknowledgement
The optional use of DE430/431 has been supported by the ESA Summer of Code in Space 2015
initiative.
10 http://catb.org/gpsd/index.html
54 Chapter 5. Files and Directories
NMEA Device
This mode is primarily for Windows users, but also for Linux and Mac users who don’t want to use
gpsd.
Virtually all GPS receivers are able to emit the standardized NMEA-0183 messages which
encode time, position, speed, satellite information and other data. The standard originally required
connection settings of 4800 baud, 8 bit, no parity, one stop bit (8N1), however some devices come
with faster transfer.
Compatible devices today are connected on a “virtual COM port” via USB. Unfortunately the
COM number seems to depend on the USB plug where you attach the receiver. You can identify
the port name (COM3, COM4, . . . ) in the Windows system configuration (Device Manager) or
with the software that came with your device.12
If this is the only serial device, Stellarium should automatically connect to it regardless of
configuration entries. If you have a device with non-standard baudrate or several serial devices on
serial ports (e.g., your telescope?), you must find out which serial port is used by the GPS device
and manually edit config.ini. Find the [gui] section and edit
[ gui ]
# These values are used on Windows primarily .
gps_interface = COM3
gps_baudrate = 4800
From now on, always use the same USB plug configuration to connect GPS and telescope.13
If GPS lookup fails, run Stellarium with the –verbose option and see the logfile for diagnostic
messages.
Bluetooth GPS
Most smartphones provide GPS and Bluetooth hardware. You can install a virtual COM port in
your Windows Bluetooth settings and use a smartphone app like BlueNMEA to provide the NMEA
strings.
udev rule which adds a unique name and use this. In this case, you may also need to add your user to the
dialout group (or whichever group owns your serial port). Better yet, use gpsd (see above).
6. Command Line Options
Stellarium’s behaviour can be modified by providing parameters to the program when it is called
via the command line. See table for a full list:
1 On Windows only
2 This function requires running in OpenGL mode.
6.1 Examples 57
If you want to avoid adding the same switch every time when you start Stellarium from the 0.15
command line, you can also set an environment variable STEL_OPTS with your default options.
6.1 Examples
• To start Stellarium using the configuration file, configuration_one.ini situated in the
user directory (use either of these):
stellarium -- config - file = configuration_one . ini
stellarium -c configuration_one . ini
• To list the available landscapes, and then start using the landscape with the ID “ocean”
stellarium -- list - landscapes
stellarium -- landscape = ocean
Note that console output (like --list-landscapes) on Windows is not possible.
3 E.g., Raspberry Pi 2/3 with Raspbian Jessie and VC4 drivers from Mesa 11 (2016).
4 http://spout.zeal.co/
7. Landscapes
G EORG Z OTTI
Landscapes are one of the key features that make Stellarium popular. Originally just used for
decoration, since version 10.6 they can be configured accurately for research and demonstra-
tion in “skyscape astronomy”, a term which describes the connection of landscape and the sky
above (Brown, 2015). Configured properly, they can act as reliable proxies of the real landscapes,
so that you can take e.g. measurements of sunrise or stellar alignments (Zotti and Neubauer, 2015),
or prepare your next moonrise photograph, as though you were on-site.
In this chapter you can find relevant information required to accurately configure Stellarium
landscapes, using panoramas created from photographs taken on-site, optionally supported by
horizon measurements with a theodolite.
Creating an accurate panorama requires some experience with photography and image process-
ing. However, great open-source tools have been developed to help you on the job. If you already
know other tools, you should be able to easily transfer the presented concepts to those other tools.
like a coordinate list or the textures. Those reside in a subdirectory of the landscape folder inside
the Stellarium program directory, or, for own work, in a subdirectory of the landscape folder
inside your Stellarium user data directory (see section 5.1).
Let us ssume we want to create a landscape for a place called Rosenburg. The location for the
files of our new custom landscape Rosenburg depends on the operating system (see 5.1). Create a
new subdirectory, and for maximum compatibility, use small letters and no spaces:
Windows C:/Users/YOU/AppData/Roaming/Stellarium/landscapes/rosenburg
Linux ~/.stellarium/landscapes/rosenburg
Mac $HOME/Library/Application Support/Stellarium/landscapes/rosenburg
[ location ]
planet = Earth
country = Austria
name = KGA Rosenburg
latitude = +48 d38 ’3.3 "
longitude ␣ = ␣ +15 d38 ’2.8 "
altitude = 266
timezone = Europe / Vienna
light_pollution = 1
at mo sp h e r i c _ e x t i n c t i o n _ c o e f f i c i e n t = 0.2
display_fog = 0
atmospheric_tempe rature = 10.0
atmospheric_pressure = 1013.0
Where:
planet Is the English name of the solar system body for the landscape.
latitude Is the latitude of site of the landscape in degrees, minutes and seconds. Positive values
represent North of the equator, negative values South of the equator.
longitude Is the longitude of site of the landscape. Positive values represent East of the Green-
wich Meridian on Earth (or equivalent on other bodies), Negative values represent Western
longitude.
altitude Is the altitude of the site of the landscape in meters.
country (optional) Name of the country the location is in.
state (optional) Name of the state the location is in.
v0.18.3 timezone (optional) IANA Timezone code
name (optional) Name of the location. This may contain spaces, but keep it short to have it fully
visible in the selection box.
Since v0.11.0, there are a few more optional parameters that can be loaded if the according switch
is active in the landscape selection panel. If they are missing, the parameters do not change to
defaults.
light_pollution (optional) Light pollution of the site, given on the Bortle Scale (1: none . . . 9:
metropolitan; see Appendix B). If negative or absent, no change will be made.
atmospheric_extinction_coefficient (optional, no change if absent.) Extinction coefficient
(mag/airmass) for this site.
7.1 Stellarium Landscapes 61
[ landscape ]
name = Geneve
type = polygonal
author = Georg Zotti ; Horizon definition by Patrick Chevalley
description = Horizon line of Geneve .
Demonstrates compatibility with
horizon descriptions from Cartes du Ciel .
polygonal_horizon_list = horizon_Geneve . txt
polygonal_angle_r otatez = 0
ground_color = .15 ,.45 ,.45
horizon_line_color = .75 ,.45 ,.45
Where:
name appears in the landscape tab of the configuration window.
type identifies the method used for this landscape. polygonal in this case.
author lists the author(s) responsible for images and composition.
description gives a short description visible in the selection panel. The text can be superseded
by optional description.<lang>.utf8 files.
polygonal_horizon_list is the name of the horizon data file for this landscape.
polygonal_horizon_list_mode (optional) the two first columns in the list are numbers: az-
imuth and altitude or zenith distance, in either degrees or radians or gradians(gon). The value
must be one of azDeg_altDeg, azDeg_zdDeg, azRad_altRad, azRad_zdRad, azGrad_altGrad,
azGrad_zdGrad. Default: azDeg_altDeg
polygonal_angle_rotatez (optional, default=0) Angle (degrees) to adjust azimuth. This may
be used to apply a (usually) small offset rotation, e.g. when you have measured the horizon
in a grid-based coordinate system like UTM and have to compensate for the meridian
convergence.
ground_color (optional, default=0,0,0, i.e., black) Color for the area below the horizon line.
Each R,G,B component is a float within 0..1.
horizon_line_color (optional, default: invisible) used to draw a polygonal horizon line. Each
R,G,B component is a float within 0..1.
minimal_brightness (optional) Some minimum brightness to keep landscape visible. Default=-
1, i.e., use minimal_brightness from the [landscape] section in the global config.ini.
minimal_altitude (optional, default=-2) Some sky elements, e.g. stars, are not drawn below
this altitude to increase performance. Under certain circumstances you may want to specify
something else here. (since v0.14.0)
polygonal_horizon_inverted (optional, default=false) In rare cases like horizon lines for high
mountain peaks with many negative horizon values this should be set to true. (since v0.15.0)
Where:
2 http://hugin.sourceforge.net/
7.1 Stellarium Landscapes 63
name appears in the landscape tab of the configuration window. This name may be translated.
type identifies the method used for this landscape. spherical in this case.
author lists the author(s) responsible for images and composition.
description gives a short description visible in the selection panel. The text will be superseded
by optional description.<lang>.utf8 files.
maptex is the name of the image file for this landscape.
maptex_top (optional; default=90) is the altitude angle of the top edge.
maptex_bottom (optional; default=-90) is the altitude angle of the bottom edge. Usually you will
not require this, or else there will be a hole at your feet, unless you also specify
bottom_cap_color (optional; default=-1.0,0.0,0.0 to signal “no color”). If set, this is used to
close any hole in the nadir area (if maptex_bottom higher than -90). v0.19.0
maptex_fog (optional; default: no fog) is the name of the fog image file for this landscape.
maptex_fog_top (optional; default=90) is the altitude angle of the top edge of the fog texture.
Useful to crop away parts of the image to conserve texture memory.
maptex_fog_bottom (optional; default=-90) is the altitude angle of the bottom edge.
maptex_illum (optional; default: no illumination layer) is the name of the nocturnal illumina-
tion/light pollution image file for this landscape.
maptex_illum_top (optional; default=90) is the altitude angle of the top edge, if you have light
pollution only close to the horizon.
maptex_illum_bottom (optional; default=-90) is the altitude angle of the bottom edge.
angle_rotatez (optional, default=0) Angle (degrees) to adjust azimuth. If 0, the left/right edge
is due east.
tesselate_rows (optional, default=20) This is the number of rows for the maptex. If straight
vertical edges in your landscape appear broken, try increasing this value, but higher values
require more computing power. Fog and illumination textures will have a similar vertical
resolution.
tesselate_cols (optional, default=40) If straight horizontal edges in your landscape appear
broken, try increasing.
polygonal_horizon_list (optional) is the name of the (measured) horizon data file for this
landscape. Can be used to define the exact position of the horizon. If missing, the texture
can be queried for horizon transparency (for accurate object rising/setting times)
polygonal_horizon_list_mode (optional) see 7.1.2
polygonal_angle_rotatez (optional, default=0) see 7.1.2
horizon_line_color see 7.1.2
minimal_brightness see 7.1.2
minimal_altitude (optional, default=-2) Some sky elements, e.g. stars, are not drawn below
this altitude for efficiency. Under certain circumstances (e.g. for space station panoramas
where you may have sky below your feet, or for deep valleys/high mountains, you may want
to specify something else here. (since v0.14.0)
To save texture memory, you can trim away the transparent sky and define the angle maptex_top.
Likewise, fogtex_top, fogtex_bottom, maptex_illum_top and maptex_illum_top. You
should then stretch the texture to a full power of 2, like 4096 × 1024 (but note that some hardware
is even limited to 2048 pixels). The easiest method to create perfectly aligned fog and illumination
layers is with an image editor that supports layers like the GIMP or Photoshop. Fog and Light
images should have black background.
Figure 7.1: Old_style landscape: eight parts delivering a high-resolution panorama. The
bottom (ground) texture, drawn on a flat plane, is not shown here.
side textures, and a separate ground texture. This has the advantage over the single-image method
that the detail level of the horizon can be increased without ending up with a single very large image
file, so this is usable for either very high-resolution panoramas or for older hardware with limited
capabilities. The ground texture can be a different resolution than the side textures. Memory usage
may be more efficient because there are no unused texture parts like the corners of the texture file
in the fish-eye method. It is even possible to repeat the horizon several times (for purely decorative
purpose). The side textures are mapped onto curved (spherical ring or cylinder) walls (Fig. 7.1).
On the negative side, it is more difficult to create this type of landscape – merging the ground
texture with the side textures can prove tricky. (Hugin can be used to create also this file, though.
And on the other hand, you can replace this by something else like a site map.) The contents of
the landscape.ini file for this landscape type is also somewhat more complicated than for other
landscape types. Here is the landscape.ini file which describes our Rosenburg landscape3 :
[ landscape ]
name = KGA Rosenburg
author = Georg Zotti , VIAS / ASTROSIM
description = KGA Rosenburg
type = old_style
nbsidetex = 8
tex0 = Horiz -0. png
tex1 = Horiz -1. png
tex2 = Horiz -2. png
tex3 = Horiz -3. png
tex4 = Horiz -4. png
tex5 = Horiz -5. png
tex6 = Horiz -6. png
tex7 = Horiz -7. png
3 the groundtex grassground.png mentioned here has been taken from the Guereins landscape.
7.1 Stellarium Landscapes 65
nbside = 8
side0 = tex0 :0:0:1:1
side1 = tex1 :0:0:1:1
side2 = tex2 :0:0:1:1
side3 = tex3 :0:0:1:1
side4 = tex4 :0:0:1:1
side5 = tex5 :0:0:1:1
side6 = tex6 :0:0:1:1
side7 = tex7 :0:0:1:1
groundtex = grassground . png
ground = groundtex :0:0:1:1
nb_decor_repeat = 1
decor_alt_angle = 82
decor_angle_shift = -62
; Rotatez deviates from -90 by the Meridian Convergence .
; The original landscape pano is grid - aligned ,
; not north - aligned !
decor_angle_rotatez = -90.525837223
ground_angle_shift = -62
ground_angle_rotatez = 44.474162777
draw_ground_first = 1
fogtex = fog . png
fog_alt_angle = 20
fog_angle_shift = -3
fog = fogtex :0:0:1:1
calibrated = true
[ location ]
planet = Earth
latitude = +48 d38 ’3.3 "
longitude ␣ = ␣ +15 d38 ’2.8 "
altitude = 266
light_pollution = 1
at mo sp h e r i c _ e x t i n c t i o n _ c o e f f i c i e n t = 0.2
display_fog = 0
atmospheric_tempe rature = 10.0
atmospheric_pressure = 1013.0
Where:
name is the name that will appear in the landscape tab of the configuration window for this
landscape
type should be old_style for the multiple image method.
author lists the author(s) responsible for images and composition.
description gives a short description visible in the selection panel. The text will be superseded
by optional description.<lang>.utf8 files.
nbsidetex is the number of side textures for the landscape.
tex0 ... tex<nbsidetex-1> are the side texture file names. These should exist in the
textures / landscapes / landscape directory in PNG format.
light0 ... light<nbsidetex-1> are optional textures. If they exist, they are used as overlays v0.13.1
on top of the respective tex<...> files and represent nocturnal illumination, e.g. street
66 Chapter 7. Landscapes
lamps, lit windows, red dots on towers, sky glow by city light pollution, . . . Empty (black)
panels can be omitted. They are rendered exactly over the tex<...> files even when the
PNG files have different size. If you need your light pollution higher in the sky, you must
use a spherical or fisheye landscape.
nbside is the number of side textures
side0 ...side<nbside-1> are the descriptions of how the side textures should be arranged in
the program. Each description contains five fields separated by colon characters (:). The
first field is the ID of the texture (e.g. tex0), the remaining fields are the texture coordinates
(x0:y0:x1:y1) used to place the texture in the scene. If you want to use all of the image,
this will just be 0:0:1:1.
groundtex is the name of the ground texture file. (This could also be a diagram e.g. indicating
the mountain peaks!)
fogtex is the name of the texture file for fog in this landscape. Fog is mapped onto a simple
cylinder.4 Note that for this landscape, accurate overlay of fog and landscape is only
guaranteed if calibrated=true and tan_mode=true.
nb_decor_repeat is the number of times to repeat the side textures in the 360 panorama. (Useful
photo panoramas should have 1 here)
decor_alt_angle (degrees) is the vertical angular extent of the textures (i.e. how many degrees
of the full altitude range they span).
decor_angle_shift (degrees) vertical angular offset of the scenery textures, at which height the
bottom line of the side textures is placed.
decor_angle_rotatez (degrees) angular rotation of the panorama around the vertical axis. This
is handy for rotating the landscape so North is in the correct direction. Note that for historical
reasons, a landscape with this value set to zero degrees has its leftmost edge pointing towards
east.
ground_angle_shift (degrees) vertical angular offset of the ground texture, at which height the
ground texture is placed.
ground_angle_rotatez (degrees) angular rotation of the ground texture around the vertical axis.
When the sides are rotated, the ground texture may need to be rotated as well to match up
with the sides.
fog_alt_angle (degrees) vertical angular size of the fog cylinder - how fog looks. Accurate
vertical size requires calibrated=true.
fog_angle_shift (degrees) vertical angular offset of the fog texture - at what height is it drawn.
Accurate vertical placement requires calibrated=true.
draw_ground_first if 1 the ground is drawn in front of the scenery, i.e. the side textures will
overlap over the ground texture.
v0.10.6 calibrated (optional). Only if true, decor_alt_angle etc. really work as documented above.
The (buggy) old code was left to work with the landscapes already existing. Note that with
“uncalibrated” landscapes, sunrise computations and similar functionality which requires an
accurate horizon line will not work.
tan_mode (optional, not used in this file). If true, the panorama image must be in in cylindrical,
not equirectangular projection. Finding decor_alt_angle and decor_angle_shift may
be a bit more difficult with this, but now (v0.13.0) works also with calibrated. A fog image
created as overlay on the pano will be perfectly placed.
decor_angle_rotatez angular rotation of the scenery around the vertical axis. This is handy for
rotating the landscape so North is in the correct direction. If 0, the left edge of tex0 is due
east.
ground_angle_shift vertical angular offset of the ground texture, at which height the ground
4 In very wide-angle views, the fog cylinder may become visible in the corners.
7.1 Stellarium Landscapes 67
texture is placed. Values above -10 are not recommended for non-photographic content (e.g.,
a map) due to high distortion.
ground_angle_rotatez angular rotation of the ground texture around the vertical axis. When
the sides are rotated, the ground texture may need to be rotated as well to match up with the
sides. If 0, east is up. if North is up in your image, set this to 90. Note that adjustments of
decor_angle_rotatez require adjustments of this angle in the opposite direction!
fog_alt_angle vertical angular size of the fog cylinder.
fog_angle_shift vertical angular offset of the fog cylinder.
draw_ground_first if 1, the ground is drawn before the sides, i.e. the side textures may overlap
the ground texture if ground_angle_shift > decor_angle_shift.
polygonal_horizon_list (optional) see 7.1.2
polygonal_horizon_list_mode (optional) see 7.1.2
polygonal_angle_rotatez (optional, default=0) see 7.1.2
horizon_line_color see 7.1.2
minimal_brightness see 7.1.2
minimal_altitude see 7.1.2
Where:
name appears in the landscape tab of the configuration window.
type identifies the method used for this landscape. fisheye in this case.
author lists the author(s) responsible for images and composition.
description gives a short description visible in the selection panel. The text will be superseded
by optional description.<lang>.utf8 files.
maptex is the name of the image file for this landscape.
maptex_fog (optional) is the name of the fog image file for this landscape.
maptex_illum (optional) is the name of the nocturnal illumination/light pollution image file for
this landscape.
68 Chapter 7. Landscapes
7.1.6 Description
The short description entry in landscape.ini will be replaced by the contents of an optional
file description.<LANG>.utf8. <LANG> is the ISO 639-1 language code, or its extension which
contains language and country code, like pt_BR for Brazilian Portuguese. The long description
requires the file description.en.utf8, this is en=english text with optional HTML tags for
sections, tables, etc. You can also have embedded images in the HTML (Views of sacred landscapes,
other informative images, . . . ?), just make them PNG format please. The length of the description
texts is not limited, you have room for a good description, links to external resources, whatever
seems suitable.
If you can provide other languages supported by Stellarium, you can provide translations
yourself, else Stellarium translators may translate the English version for you. (It may take years
though.) The file ending .utf8 indicates that for special characters like ÄÖÜßáé you should use
UTF8 encoding. If you write only English/ASCII, this may not be relevant.
Figure 7.3: Zenit “Horizon 202” panorama camera with rotating lens for 35mm film.
(Source: Wikipedia, “Horizon202” by BillC - Own Work. Licensed under CC BY-SA 3.0 via Wikimedia
Commons - https://commons.wikimedia.org/wiki/File:Horizon202.jpg)
camera!
The images should match in brightness and white balance. If you can shoot in RAW, do so to
be able to change white balance later. If the camera can only create JPG, ensure you have set the
camera to a suitable white balance before taking the photos and not to “auto”, because this may
find different settings and thus give colour mismatches. Exposure brightness differences can be
largely removed during stitching, but good, well-exposed original shots always give better results.
As a general recommendation, the images of a panorama should be taken from left to right,
else please accordingly invert some of the instructions given below.
There are several panorama making programs. Often they are included in the software that
comes with a digital camera and allow the creation of simple panoramas. Other software titles are
available for purchase. However, there is one cost-free open-source program that does everything
we need for our task, and much more:
match the number of cores in your computer and allow parallel processing. E.g., if you have an
Intel Core-i7, you usually can set up to 8 cores (4 cores with hyperthreading; but maybe leave
one core for your other tasks while you wait for a processing job?). If your PC is equipped with a
modern programmable graphics card, you can enable its use in the Programs tab with activating
“Use GPU for remapping”.
After that, we are ready for creating our panoramas.
Multi-ring Panoramas
If you are trying to create a panorama with several rings (horizon, one or two rings below, and
nadir area), you must try to create/keep control points that best give a result without visible seams.
In this case, and esp. if you have only used a regular tripod or even dared to go for a free-handed
9 You should have created control points with the Celeste option!
74 Chapter 7. Landscapes
panorama, you may observe that it is best to remove control points in neighboring photos in the
lower rings, but keep only the “vertical” links between images with similar azimuth.
In total, and if the foreground is not important but only grassy or sandy, the rule of thumb is
that the horizon images must be strongly linked with good quality (small errors), while images in
the lower rings should be linked mostly to their respective upper photos, but not necessarily to the
images to its sides. The resulting panorama will then show a good horizon line, while stitching
artifacts in a grassy or otherwise only decorative ground will usually be acceptable and can, if
needed, be camouflaged in postprocessing.
This optimisation and editing of control points is likely a longish iterative process, and these
are the late night hours where you will finally wish you had used a panorama head. . .
Masking
If you have images with overlapping areas, you can usually not force Hugin to take pixels from the
image which you find best. you can however mask off an area from an image which you don’t want
to see in the output under any circumstances, e.g. a person’s arm or foot in one image. Just open
the image in the Mask tab and either press Add new mask and draw the mask polygon covering
the unwanted area, or use the crop settings to define rectangular areas to use.
Exposure disbalance
In the Photos tab, select Photometric parameters on the right side. The EV column lists the
Exposure Value. If you see disbalance here and in the preview window, you can run a photometric
optimisation with the lowest button on the Photos tab. Simply select Low dynamic range and press
Calculate . The preview should now show a seamless image. If all else fails, you can edit the EV
values directly.
Advanced photographers may want to correct exposures in their RAW images before creating
JPG or TIF images to combine with Hugin. This unfortunately may create exposure disbalance
because the EXIF tags may not be adjusted accordingly, so based on different exposure/f-stop
conbinations Hugin may think it has to re-balance the values. In these cases, don’t run the
photometric optimiser. Some image exposure values have to be changed manually, and the effect
supervised in the preview window. Usually the smooth blending in the subprogam enblend called
by Hugin will hide remaining differences.
Stitching
When you are happy with the panorama in the preview window and the matchpoints promise a good
fit, it is time to finally create the panorama image. Hugin can create a large number of different
projections which all have their application. For Stellarium, we can only use the equirectangular
projection. You still have 2 options:
spherical landscapes (see 7.1.3) require single equirectangular images, the maximum size depends
on your graphics hardware and Qt limitations and is likely not larger than 8192 × 4096
pixels.
old_style landscapes (see 7.1.4) can use several textures for the ring along the horizon, and one
image for the nadir zone. If you need high resolution, you should aim for creating this one.
Sometimes, creating the nadir zone is difficult: this is where usually the view is blocked by the
tripod, and we are not interested in views of tripod or our own feet. For our purpose it is usually
enough to fill in the feet area using the clone stamp, or a monochrome color, or, for old_style
landscapes, you can instead insert an oriented site map or wind rose.
There is a button create optimal size in Hugin. It may recommend a panorama width around
13.000 pixels for an average camera and photos taken with a wide-angle lens. Increasing this size
will most likely not lead to higher optical resolution! The panorama width which you can most
usefully create depends on the resolution of the source images (which leads to the result given by
7.3 Panorama Postprocessing 75
Hugin) and on your needs. If you need arcminute resolution, you would aim for 360 × 60 = 21600
pixels, which cannot be loaded into graphics memory in a single piece, i.e., is too large for
Stellarium, and must be configured as old_style landscape. In this case, 10 or 11 tiles of
2048 × 2048 pixels (totalling 20480 or 22528 pixels) is the closest meaningful setting, i.e., you
could create an image of 20480 pixels width and cut this into usable pieces. Usually, a size
of 4096 × 2048 or 8192 × 4096 pixels (for better computers) is enough, and can be used in a
spherical landscape.
We have to edit the file after stitching, therefore select creation of an image in the TIFF format.
LZW compression is non-lossy, so use this to keep file size reasonably small.
For regular images, it is enough to create “Exposure corrected, low dynamic range”. If you
have a problem with persons that have moved between your images, you may want to post-process
the final result with import of the distorted sub-images and manually defining the best blending line.
For this, find the “Remapped Images” group and again activate “Exposure corrected, low dynamic
range”.
Now, press the Stitch! button in the lower right corner. This opens a helper program which
supervises the stitching process. Depending on your computer and size of the image, it will require
a few minutes of processing.
In case stitching fails with a cryptic error message, try to add the option --fine-mask to the
enblend options.
Store a copy of the Hugin project file to always be able to go back to the settings you used to
create the last panorama. We will get back to it when we want to make a truly calibrated panorama
(see 7.3.3).
Photoshop. Simply mark the sky, and then delete it. The checkerboard background indicates
transparent pixels.
It sometimes helps to put an intensive bright red or blue background layer under the panorama
photo to see the last remaining clouds and other specks. In the layer dialog, create a new layer,
bucket-fill with blue or red, and drag it in the layer dialog below the pano layer. Write-protect this
layer, work on the image layer, and before exporting the image layer with transparent sky to PNG,
don’t forget to switch off the background.
We need this layer functionality especially to align the panorama on a calibration grid, see
section 7.3.3.
7.3.2 ImageMagick
ImageMagick (IM)10 can be described as “Swiss Army Knife of image manipulation”. It can do
most operations usually applied to images in a GUI program, but is called from the command line.
This allows also to include IM in your own command scripts11 . We will use it to do our final cut
and resize operations. I cannot give an exhaustive tutorial about more than a few of IM’s functions,
but the commands given here should be enough for our purpose.
To open a command window (console, a.k.a. DOS window), press the Windows key and enter
cmd, then press . (On Linux and Mac, you surely know how to open a console window.)
There are some things you might need to know:
• The command line is not your enemy, but a way to call expert tools.
• The Windows command line processor cmd.exe is far from user friendly.
• There are remedies and alternatives. See notes on clink (7.4.3) for a considerable improve-
ment, and Cygwin (7.4.4) for experts.
# image lines
# - hugin cropFactor =1
i w16384 h8192 f4 v360 Ra0 Rb0 Rc0 Rd0 Re0 Eev0 Er1 Eb1 r0
p90 y0 TrX0 TrY0 TrZ0 Tpy0 Tpp0 j0 a0 b0 c0 d0 e0 g0 t0
Va1 Vb0 Vc0 Vd0 Vx0 Vy0 Vm5 n " Eqirect_Pano360 . png "
Figure 7.5: Project file ground.pto usable to create the ground image with Hugin or, on
the command line, its nona stitcher. The last line, starting with i, has been wrapped, but
must be 1 line.
78 Chapter 7. Landscapes
Say, the side panels extend down to decor_angle_shift=-44 degrees, which means you
must close the ground with a Nadir FoV = 2 × (90 − 44) = 92. For maximum compatibility, we
will again make an image of width and height both 2048px. These values can be found in the p line
in Figure 7.5. The i line describes the input image, which is our full equirectangular pano of width
w= 16384 and height h= 8192. The last argument of that line is the image file name.
For processing, we do not use the Hugin GUI, but simply the command line. The actual
program to call is nona. If your stitched panorama is a 16-bit TIFF, nona will also make a 16-bit
image, but our textures are limited to 8-bit PNGs. We apply our most useful tool, convert from the
ImageMagick suite.
Figure 7.6: Hugin’s Fast Panorama Preview can be used to check which images are
connected to its neighbours. Most important are good matches along the horizon, the
images in the lower rows are clearly less important. If captured on a tripod, they should
still match.
Within a few rounds of adjustments, panorama creation, adding as layer in the image editor,
and comparing to the reference data, you should achieve a match to fit your needs.
In case you have taken photographs in several rings but without a panorama tripod, you
may have to first align only the horizontal images (deselect the lower images to exclude from
optimisation), and when the horizon ring is aligned perfectly, deactivate further optimisation in
Hugin for those photos while “attaching” (optimising) the lower photos. In Hugin’s Photos tab,
select Optimise Geometric Custom Parameters . This opens an extra tab Optimiser , where
you can fine-tune your needs: Switch off all variables for the photos in the horizon ring, and make
sure the lower photos fit in the preview after optimisation.
It may even help to define that the lower rows have been taken with a different Lens, so the
field of view and distortion settings of the horizon row will be used as it had been found during the
horizon-only match.
By now you should have enough experience what level of error may be acceptable for you.
80 Chapter 7. Landscapes
not work, towards the city the horizon is much brighter. Use a huge but weak brush to make
a more spotty sky.
• Use the existing landscape as template for the layer mask for this gradient sky layer. (You
want to hide skyglow by leaves in the foreground!)
• If you want to add only a few lights to an old_style landscape, you need to provide only
the panels showing those lights. Just load a side panel for reference, place a new layer on top,
and paint the lights on windows, lamps etc. There is no light option for the ground texture.
This makes old_style landscapes best suited for localized light pollution, not city skyglow.
The resulting image is then declared in the maptex_illum line of landscape.ini. Try also
to balance the global strength of light pollution with the light_pollution key, and a probable
minimal brightness with the minimal_brightness key.
Try to match the visual appearance, not necessarily what photographs may have recorded.
E.g., the Grossmugl sky shows horizon glow mostly towards the city of Vienna, where long-time
exposures may already be saturated.
The possibilities seem limited only by your time and skills!
7.4.1 IrfanView
IrfanView is a free image viewer for Windows with many options. It can show almost any image
format, including several camera RAW formats, in windowed and full-screen mode. It is definitely
preferrable over any image viewer built into Windows. Unfortunately however, it has no panorama
viewer function!
7.4.2 FSPViewer
FSPViewer16 by Fulvio Senore is an excellent panorama viewer for equirectanglar images. Images
centered along the horizon can be viewed directly, while settings for images with different minimum
and maximum angles, as well as “hotspots” (similar to hyperlinks) which move to neighboring
panoramas, can be configured in an .FSV text file like figure 7.7.
7.4.3 Clink
Clink17 is a command line enhancement for Windows developed by Martin Ridgers. If you have
ever worked under a Linux bash-like command line, you will easily feel that Windows’ cmd.exe
16 Further details are available on its home page http://www.fsoft.it/FSPViewer/.
17 http://mridgers.github.io/clink/
82 Chapter 7. Landscapes
is extremely limited. Clink provides several useful features, most notably a really usable command-
line completion. It is not essential for our tasks, but a general improvement of usability of the
Windows command line which else has not caused me any trouble.
7.4.4 Cygwin
Compared to Linux, the command line of Windows can be a humbling experience. None of the
wonderful helpers taken for granted on Linux are available. Cygwin18 provides a command line
console with bash shell and all the niceties like make, awk, sed, etc. which seem essential for
routine work. If you are used to Linux tools, use inline scripts in your Makefiles and need more
than Clink can offer, you should install Cygwin.
7.4.5 GNUWin32
Alternative to Cygwin, several of those nice tools (sed, awk etc.) have also been made available as
standalone commands for Windows. If you don’t need the inline scripting capabilities in Makefiles
which you would get from Cygwin but just want to call awk or sed inside your .BAT scripts, maybe
this is enough.
18 https://cygwin.com/index.html
8. Deep-Sky Objects
Since version 0.10.0 Stellarium uses the “json” cataloguing system of configuring textures. At
the same time the Simbad online catalogue was added to the search feature, making the catalog
somewhat redundant and used now only as a first search point or if there is no internet connection.
If the object has a name (not just a catalogue number), you should add one or more records to
the .../nebulae/default/names.dat file (where ... is either the installation directory or the
user directory). See section 8.1.2 Modifying names.dat for details of the file format.
If you wish to associate a texture (image) with the object, you must add a record to the
.../nebulae/default/textures.json file. See section 8.1.3 for details of the file format.
If you wish to associate an outline with the object, you must add the series of lines to the
.../nebulae/default/outlines.dat file. See section 8.1.4 for details of the file format.
The file catalog.txt should be put into the directory .../nebulae/default/ and you
should create an empty file catalog.pack to storing the binary catalog. After converting the data
into binary format you should gzip them by the command
1 Anextended edition of this catalog with over one million objects may be downloaded and installed
manually (see section 5.5.2).
84 Chapter 8. Deep-Sky Objects
4 float B magnitude
5 float V magnitude
6 string Object type (See section 8.1.1 for details).
7 string Morphological type of object
8 float Major axis size or radius (arcmin)
9 float Minor axis size (arcmin)
10 integer Orientation angle (degrees)
11 float Redshift
12 float Error of redshift
13 float Parallax (mas)
14 float Error of parallax (mas)
15 float Non-redshift distance ( Mpc for galaxies, kpc for other objects)
16 float Error of non-redsift distance ( Mpc for galaxies, kpc for other objects)
17 integer NGC number (New General Catalogue)
18 integer IC number (Index Catalogue)
19 integer M number (Messier Catalog)
20 integer C number (Caldwell Catalogue)
21 integer B number (Barnard Catalogue)
22 integer SH2 number (Sharpless Catalogue)
23 integer VdB number (van den Bergh Catalogue of reflection nebulae)
24 integer RCW number (A catalogue of Hα-emission regions in the southern
Milky Way)
25 integer LDN number (Lynds’ Catalogue of Dark Nebulae)
26 integer LBN number (Lynds’ Catalogue of Bright Nebulae)
27 integer Cr number (Collinder Catalogue)
28 integer Mel number (Melotte Catalogue of Deep Sky Objects)
29 integer PGC number (HYPERLEDA. I. Catalog of galaxies); partial
30 integer UGC number (The Uppsala General Catalogue of Galaxies); partial
31 string Ced identificator (Cederblad Catalog of bright diffuse Galactic nebulae)
32 integer Arp number (Atlas of Peculiar Galaxies)
33 integer VV number (The catalogue of interacting galaxies)
34 string PK identificator (Catalogue of Galactic Planetary Nebulae)
35 string PN G identificator (The Strasbourg-ESO Catalogue of Galactic Planetary
Nebulae)
36 string SNR G identificator (A catalogue of Galactic supernova remnants)
37 string ACO identificator (A Catalog of Rich Clusters of Galaxies)
38 string HCG identificator (Atlas of compact groups of galaxies)
39 string Abell identificator (Abell Catalog of Planetary Nebulae)
40 string ESO identificator (ESO/Uppsala Survey of the ESO(B) Atlas)
Types of Objects
Possible values for type of objects in the file catalog.dat.
Type Description
G Galaxy
GX Galaxy
AGX Active Galaxy
RG Radio Galaxy
IG Interacting Galaxy
86 Chapter 8. Deep-Sky Objects
GC Globular Cluster
OC Open Cluster
NB Nebula
PN Planetary Nebula
DN Dark Nebula
RN Reflection Nebula
C+N Cluster associated with nebulosity
HII HII Region
SNR Supernova Remnant
SNC Supernova Candidate
SNRC Supernova Remnant Candidate
BN Bipolar Nebula
EN Emission Nebula
SA Stellar Association
SC Star Cloud
CL Cluster
IR Infra-Red Object
QSO Quasar
Q? Possible Quasar
ISM Interstellar Matter
EMO Emission Object
LIN LINEAR-type Active Galaxies
BLL BL Lac Object
BLA Blazar
MOC Molecular Cloud
YSO Young Stellar Object
PN? Possible Planetary Nebula
PPN Protoplanetary Nebula
∗ Star
∗∗ Double Star
MUL Multiple Star
SY∗ Symbiotic Star
EM∗ Emission-line Star
CLG Cluster of galaxies
empty Unknown type, catalog errors, Unidentified Southern Objects etc.
Each line in the file names.dat contains one record. A record relates an extended object catalogue
number (from catalog.dat) with a name. A single catalogue number may have more than one
record in this file.
The record structure is as follows:
Offset Length Type Description
0 5 %5s Designator for catalogue (prefix)
5 15 %d Identificator for object in the catalog
20 60 %s Proper name of the object (translatable)
If an object has more than one record in the file names.dat, the last record in the file will be used
for the nebula label.
8.1 Stellarium DSO Catalog 87
where
worldCoords Decimal numerical values of the J2000 coordinates (RA and dec both in degrees) of
the corners of the texture. These values are usually given to 4 decimal places.
88 Chapter 8. Deep-Sky Objects
textureCoords Where 0,0 is South Left, 1,0 the South Right, 1,1 North Right, 0,1 North Left
corners of the texture.
MinResolution UNDOCUMENTED VALUE! Sorry!
maxBrightness total object brightness, magnitude
Calculating of the coords of the corners of the images (plate solving) is a time consuming
project and needs to be fine tuned from the screen display. As most images will be two dimensional,
display on a spherical display will limit the size to about 1 degree before distortion becomes evident.
Larger images should be sectioned into a mosaic of smaller textures for a more accurate display.
V0.16.1 Each line in the file outlines.dat contains three “columns” of data for outline elements. The
structure for each line is as follows:
Coordinates for each point of outline is represented in the equatorial coordinate system for epoch
J2000.0. The possible values of the third “column” (Command) are:
start This command marks a start point of the outline. This command should also contain the
designation of the deep-sky object.
vertex This command marks an intermediate point of the outline.
end This command marks an end point of the outline.
Example for outline of M42:
The format of the file outlines.dat is compatible with the similar file of the SkyChart/-
Cartes du Ciel planetarium.
8.2 Adding Extra Nebulae Images 89
Figure 8.3: ReadDSS: A program to write a textures.json insert with epoch manipula-
tion.
it on the clipboard. Run TheSky and centre on the object centre. Look in the Tools menu for the
image link and select setup . Tick show image frame to put a frame around the image.
Paste the clipboard image on the display and use the zoom and position controls to get it as
close to the size and position as possible by visually matching stars. Go to the menu again and click
on link wizard . If you have been successful the window will show the number of stars matched
and the option to accept or continue . Accept and you will now see all the matched stars have
overlaid the picture. You can now read off the corner coordinates from the status bar starting at the
bottom (south) left and continuing counterclockwise to the top (north) left.
Stellarium comes with a nice set of skycultures. For ethnographers or historians of science it may
be a worthwile consideration to illustrate the sky culture of the people they are studying. It is not
very hard to do so, but depending on your data, may require some skills in image processing.
Some features regarding translation and multilinguality have evolved over the years, and not
all skycultures currently included in Stellarium adhere to the standards described in the following
sections. Skycultures will also see continuous development in the coming versions. If you add a
new skyculture, please adhere to this description for an optimal result!
In the Stellarium program folder you can see a folder skycultures. Let us assume you work
on Windows and want to create a new Skyculture, say, myCulture.
You can take the inuit directory as template to start with. Just copy the folder C:\Program
Files\Stellarium\skycultures\inuit to C:\Users\[YOU]\AppData\Roaming\Stellarium\
skycultures\myculture
In the folder you see image files for the constellation artwork, and all other files with various
extensions are text files.
(or what seems best for you). The name is used for the list entry in the Starlore tab in the View
dialog (see 4.4.6).
94 Chapter 9. Adding Sky Cultures
The option “boundaries” is optional and may contain the follow values:
none — this value is enabled by default and it designates that this culture doesn’t have boundaries
of constellations.
iau — use this value for variants of “western” cultures to enable using default (IAU) boundaries.
own — please use it for culture who has own set of boundaries for constellations.
v0.19.0 The option “classification” is also optional. It allows some form of quality control:
personal – this is a personally developed skyculture which is not founded in published historical
or ethnological research. Stellarium may include it when it is “pretty enough” without really
approving its contents.
traditional – (default value) content represents “common” knowledge by several members of an
ethnic community, and the skyculture has been developed by members of such community.
Our “Western” skyculture is a key example: it has evolved for about 2500 years, and modern
astronomers use it.
ethnographic – provided by ethnographic researchers based on interviews of indigenous people.
historical – based on historical written sources from a (usually short) period of the past.
single – represents a single source like a historical atlas, or publications of a single author.
is shown. If your skyculture is a variant of the Western skyculture, please use the canonical Latin
names, they have all been translated already.
If your skyculture is not a variant of the generally known Western skyculture, please include an
English translation to the name given in the native language. Else translators will not be able to
translate the name. See a good example in the Mongolian skyculture.
In the sample you can see 3 lines: the first line is a comment, the second line has 3 fields and
the third line has 2 fields. Both lines with data have the same Hipparcos number of the star —
Fomalhaut is the well-known name of HIP 113368, and Thalim is an additional (not well-known)
name of this star.
In this file,
Abbr is the abbreviation defined in constellation_names.eng.fab
pairs is the number of line pairs which follow.
pairN_starA Hipparcos numbers for the stars which form the constellation stick figure. We need
two entries per line, longer line segments are not supported. To find the HIP number, just
have Stellarium open and click on the star in Stellarium while editing this file.
where
N number of segments for boundary
RA_n, DE_n right ascension (decimal hours) and declination (decimal degrees) of the points of
segments in J2000 coordinates.
2 CON1 CON2 this data indicate “border between 2 constellations CON1 and CON2”. They
are used to define isolated boundaries for each constellation (for proper working of the
Select single constellation option).
where
Abbr is the abbreviation defined in constellation_names.eng.fab
image_name.png is the file name of your texture. It should be sized in a power of two, like
512 × 512, 1024 × 2048 etc. Avoid dimensions larger than 2048, they are not supported on
all systems. You can distort images to better exploit the pixels, the texture will be stretched
back. The background of the artwork image must be absolutely black.
xn, yn, HIPn (n ∈ [1, 2, 3]) pixel locations of the star in the constellation drawing (find those in
any image editor) and HIPn is the star number in the Hipparcos catalog, which you find
when you click on the star in Stellarium.
1 Please define “boundaries = own” in the file info.ini to enable using custom boundaries.
9.10 Seasonal Rules 97
In case the artwork is only available in a certain projection (e.g., an all-sky map), or is otherwise
heavily distorted so that the match is not satisfactory, you may have to reproject the image somehow.
For aligning, you should switch Stellarium to Stereographic projection for optimal results.
You don’t have to shutdown and restart Stellarium during creation/matching, just switch
skyculture to something else and back to the new one to reload.
This specifies that constellation Emu (abbreviated also as “Emu”) is visible only from June to
March.
9.11 References
The file reference.fab contains a list of information sources. Each line of the file contains one v0.15.1
record of 3 fields, separated by the pipe character (|) — number of source, description of source
and optional URL, e.g.:
9| Kruger 60| https :// en . wikipedia . org / wiki / Kruger_60
This file will be used in future versions. It is most important for “traditional” skycultures
collected from various sources to provide traceable references.
or
Abbr 2 pairs pair1_RA1 pair1_DE1 pair1_RA2 pair1_DE2 pair2_RA1 ...
In this file,
98 Chapter 9. Adding Sky Cultures
2 https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by/4.0/
3 https://creativecommons.org/licenses/by-sa/4.0/
10. Surveys
G UILLAUME C HÉREAU
10.1 Introduction
A sky survey is a map of the sky stored as a hierarchical set of a potentially large number of smaller v0.18.0
images (called tiles). The advantage compared to a regular texture is that we need to render only
the visible tiles of a potentially gigantic image at the lowest resolution needed. This is particularly
interesting for rendering online images that can be stored on a server, while the client only has to
download the parts he currently uses.
Since version 0.18.0, Stellarium added some preliminary support for loading and rendering on-
line surveys in the Hierarchical Progressive Surveys (HiPS) format, developed by the International
Virtual Observatory Alliance. A full description of the format can be found on the IVOA website1 .
As of v0.18.0, by default Stellarium tries to load HiPS from two sources: http://alaskybis.
unistra.fr/hipslist and https://data.stellarium.org/surveys/hipslist. This can
be changed with the hips/sources options in the configuration file (see also section D.1.27). For
example:
1 http://www.ivoa.net/documents/HiPS/20170519/REC-HIPS-1.0-20170519.pdf
100 Chapter 10. Surveys
[ hips ]
sources / size = 1
sources /1/ url = " https :// myownhips / hipslist "
toast_survey_levels =10
16 Scripting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191
11. Plugins: An Introduction
Starting with version 0.10.3, Stellarium’s packages have included a steadily growing number
of optional extensions called plug-ins: Angle Measure, Compass Marks, Oculars, Telescope
Control, Text User Interface, Satellites, Solar System Editor, Historical Novae and Supernovae,
Quasars, Pulsars, Exoplanets, Observability analysis, ArchaeoLines, Scenery3D, RemoteControl
and RemoteSync. All these plug-ins are “built-in” in the standard Stellarium distribution and don’t
need to be downloaded separately.
1. Open the Configuration dialog (press F2 or use the left tool bar button )
2. Select the Plugins tab
3. Select the plugin you want to enable from the list
4. Check the Load at startup option
5. Restart Stellarium
If the plugin has configuration options, the configuration button will be enabled when the plugin
has been loaded and clicking it will open the plugin’s configuration dialog. When you only just
activated loading of a plugin, you must restart Stellarium to access the plugin’s configuration dialog.
You can modify the catalog.json files manually using a text editor. If you are using
Windows, it is strongly recommended to use an advanced text editor such as Notepad++1 to
avoid problems with end-of-line characters. (It will also color the JSON code and make it easier
to read.)
Warning: Before editing your catalog.json file, make a backup copy. Leaving out the
smallest detail (such as a comma or forgetting to close a curly bracket) may prevent Stellarium
from starting.
As stated in section 5, the path to the directory2 which contains catalog.json file is something
like:
Windows C:\Users\UserName\AppData\Roaming\Stellarium\modules\PluginName
Mac OS X HomeDirectory/Library/Application Support/Stellarium/modules/PluginName
Linux and UNIX-like OS ~/.stellarium/modules/PluginName
1 http://notepad-plus-plus.org/
2 This is a hidden folder, so in order to find it you may need to change your computer’s settings to display
hidden files and folders.
12. Interface Extensions
Most users will soon be familiar with the usual user interface. A few plugins are available which
extend the regular user interface with a few small additions which are presented first. However, some
applications and installations of Stellarium require completely different user interfaces. Mostly,
these serve to avoid showing the user interface panels to an audience, be that in your astronomy
club presentations, a domed planetarium or in a museum installation.
The Angle Measure plugin is a small tool which is used to measure the angular distance between
two points on the sky.
1. Enable the tool by clicking the tool-bar button, or by pressing Ctrl + A . A message will
appear at the bottom of the screen to tell you that the tool is active.
2. Drag a line from the first point to the second point using the left mouse button
3. To clear the measurement, click the right mouse button
4. To deactivate the angle measure tool, press the tool-bar button again, or press Ctrl + A on
the keyboard.
In the configuration dialog, you can configure if you want to have distances given on the rotating
sphere, or in horizontal (alt-azimuthal) coordinates. You can also link one point to the resting
horizon, the other to the sky and observe how angles change.
108 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
25 25
Cnc Cnc
20 Leo Gem 20 Leo Gem
15 15
Vir Tau Vir Tau
10 10
5 5
Figure 12.2: Figure-8 plots for Equation of Time, for years 1000 (left) and 2000 (right).
These plots, often found on sundials, link solar declination (vertical axis) and its deviation
at mean noon from the meridian, in minutes. Labeled dots indicate when the sun entered
the respective Zodiacal sign (30◦ section of the ecliptic). Figures by Georg Zotti.
The Equation of Time plugin shows the solution of the equation of time. This describes the
discrepancy between two kinds of solar time:
Apparent solar time directly tracks the motion of the sun. Most sundials show this time.
Mean solar time tracks a fictitious “mean” sun with noons 24 hours apart.
There is no universally accepted definition of the sign of the equation of time. Some publications
show it as positive when a sundial is ahead of a clock; others when the clock is ahead of the sundial.
In the English-speaking world, the former usage is the more common, but is not always followed.
Anyone who makes use of a published table or graph should first check its sign usage.
If enabled (see section 11.1), click on the Equation of Time button on the bottom toolbar
to display the value for the equation of time on top of the screen.
12.3.1 Section EquationOfTime in config.ini file
You can edit config.ini file by yourself for changes of the settings for the Equation of Time
plugin – just make it carefully!
ID Type Description
enable_at_startup bool Display solution of the equation of time at startup of Stel-
larium
flag_use_ms_format bool Set format for the displayed solution – minutes and seconds
or decimal minutes
flag_use_inverted_value bool Change sign of the equation of time
flag_show_button bool Show the tool’s button on the bottom toolbar
text_color R,G,B Font color for the displayed solution of the equation of time
font_size int Font size for the displayed solution of the equation of time
110 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
By default Stellarium uses smooth zooming via mouse wheel or keyboard shortcuts. Some users may
want stepwise zooming to fixed values for field of view like in the Cartes du Ciel1 planetarium
program, and this plugin provides this feature. You can edit values and use the keyboard for
quick-setting of FOV. All values in degrees.
1. Enable the tool by configuring it to “Load at startup”.
2. Press shortkeys for quick changes of FOV.
12.4.1 Section FOV in config.ini file
You can configure the plugin with its dialog (Fig. 12.3) or edit config.ini file by yourself for
changes of the settings for the Field of View plugin – just make it carefully!
The Pointer Coordinates plugin shows the coordinates of the mouse pointer. If enabled, click on the
plugin button on the bottom toolbar to display the coordinates of the mouse pointer.
12.5.1 Section PointerCoordinates in config.ini file
You can edit config.ini file by yourself for changes of the settings for the Pointer Coordinates
plugin – just make it carefully!
ID Type Description
enable_at_startup bool Enable displaying mouse pointer coordinates at pro-
gram startup
flag_show_button bool Show the plugin’s tool button on the bottom toolbar
text_color R,G,B Color for coordinates text of the mouse pointer
font_size int Font size for the displayed mouse pointer coordinates
current_displaying_place string Specifies the place of displaying coordinates of
the mouse pointer. Possible values: TopRight,
TopCenter, RightBottomCorner, Custom. Default
value: TopRight.
custom_coordinates int,int Specifies the screen coordinates of the custom place
for displaying coordinates of the mouse pointer
current_coordinate_system string Specifies the coordinate system. Possible values:
RaDecJ2000, RaDec, HourAngle, Ecliptic, AltAzi,
Galactic. Default value: RaDecJ2000.
flag_show_constellation bool Add the 3-letter IAU abbreviation for the constellation
of the mouse pointer location (Roman, 1987).
flag_show_crossed_lines bool Show crossed lines under mouse cursor.
112 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
2 This used to be hard-coded to M before version 0.15, but Alt + T is better to remember as it runs
parallel with Ctrl + T for switching the GUI panels, and frees up M for the Milky Way. The Alt + T
keybinding is hardcoded, i.e., cannot be reconfigured by the user, and should not be used for another function.
12.6 Text User Interface Plugin 113
3.2 Sky Language Change the language used to describe objects in the sky
3.3 App Language Change the application language (used in GUIs)
4 Stars (menu group)
4.1 Show stars Turn on/off star rendering
4.2 Relative Scale Change the relative brightness of the stars. Larger values
make bright stars much larger.
4.3 Absolute Scale Change the absolute brightness of the stars. Large values
show more stars. Leave at 1 for realistic views.
4.4 Twinkle Sets how strong the star twinkling effect is - zero is off,
the higher the value the more the stars will twinkle.
5 Colors (menu group) change color/brightness of the. . .
5.1 Constellation lines constellation lines
5.2 Constellation labels labels used to name stars
5.3 Art brightness constellation art
5.4 Constellation boundaries constellation boundary lines
5.5 Cardinal points cardinal points markers
5.6 Planet labels labels for planets
5.7 Planet orbits orbital guide lines for planets
5.8 Planet trails planet trails lines
5.9 Meridian Line meridian line
5.10 Azimuthal Grid lines and labels for the azimuthal grid
5.11 Equatorial Grid lines and labels for the equatorial grid
5.12 Equatorial J2000 Grid lines and labels for the equatorial J2000.0 grid
5.13 Equator Line equator line
5.14 Ecliptic Line ecliptic line
5.15 Ecliptic Line (J2000) J2000 ecliptic line
5.16 Nebula names labels for nebulae
5.17 Nebula hints circles used to mark positions of unspecified nebulae
5.18 Galaxy hints ellipses used to mark positions of galaxies
5.19 Bright nebula hints squares used to mark positions of bright nebulae
5.20 Dark nebula hints squares used to mark positions of dark nebulae
5.21 Clusters hints symbols used to mark positions of clusters
5.22 Horizon line horizon line
5.23 Galactic grid galactic grid
5.24 Galactic equator line galactic equator line
5.25 Opposition/conjunction longi- opposition/conjunction line
tude line
5.26 Sky background sky background. Note that anything but black is only
useful for artistic works.
6 Effects (menu group)
6.1 Light Pollution Changes the intensity of the light pollution (see Ap-
pendix B Bortle Scale index)
6.2 Landscape Select the landscape which Stellarium draws when
ground drawing is enabled. Press to activate.
6.3 Setting Landscape Sets Loca- If “Yes” then changing the landscape will move the
tion observer location to the location for that landscape (if
one is known). Setting this to “No” means the observer
location is not modified when the landscape is changed.
114 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
6.4 Auto zoom out returns to ini- Changes the behaviour when zooming out from a se-
tial . . . view lected object. When set to “Off”, selected object will
stay in center. When set to “On”, view will return to
startup view.
6.5 Zoom Duration Sets the time for zoom operations to take (in seconds)
6.6 Milky Way intensity Changes the brightness of the Milky Way
6.7 Zodiacal light intensity Changes the brightness of the Zodiacal light
7 Scripts (menu group)
7.1 Run local script Run a script from the scripts sub-directory of the User
Directory or Installation Directory (see section 5 (Files
and Directories))
7.1 Stop running script Stop execution of a currently running script
8 Administration (menu group)
8.1 Load default configuration Reset all settings according to the main configuration
file
8.2 Save current configuration Save the current settings to the main configuration file
8.3 Shutdown Emits a command configured in
12.6.3 Section tui in config.ini file
The section in config.ini for this plugin is named only [tui] for historical reasons. As always,
be careful when editing!
ID Type Description
tui_font_color R,G,B Font color for TUI text
tui_font_size int Font size for the TUI
flag_show_gravity_ui bool Bend menu text around the screen center. May be
useful in planetarium setups, and should then be used
together with “Disc viewport” in the configuration
menu (see 4.3.5).
flag_show_tui_datetime bool Show date and time in lower center.
flag_show_tui_short_obj_info bool Show some object info in lower right, or (in plane-
tarium setups with “Disc viewport” active,) wrapped
along the outer circle border.
admin_shutdown_cmd string executable command to shutdown your system. Best
used on Linux or Mac systems. E.g. shutdown -h
now
12.7 Remote Control Plugin 115
After enabling the plugin, you can set it up through the configuration dialog. You can configure
it to start the web server automatically whenever Stellarium starts or manually start/stop the server
using the “Server enabled” checkbox or the button in the toolbar.
The plugin starts an HTTP server on the specified port. The default port is 8090, so you should
reach the remote control after enabling it by starting a web browser on the same computer and
entering http://localhost:8090 in the address bar. When trying to access the remote control
from another computer, you need the IP address or the hostname of the server on which Stellarium
runs. On a small tablet, you may want to use http://myserver:8090/tablet7in.html instead.
116 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
The plugin shows the locally detected address, but depending on your network or if you need
external access you might need to use a different one — contact your network administrator if you
need help with that.
The access to the remote control may optionally be restricted with a simple password.
Warning: currently no network encryption is used, meaning that an attacker having access to
your network can easily find out the password by waiting for a user entering it. Access from the
Internet to the plugin should generally be restricted, except if countermeasures such as VPN usage
are taken! If you are in a home network using NAT (network access translation), this should be
enough for basic security except if port forwarding or a DMZ is configured.
This allows triggering automatic show setups for museums etc. via some centralized schedulers
like cron.
To get a complete pretty-printed list of properties, use:
curl -G -d ’ id = propId = -1& actionId = -2 ’ http :// localhost :8090/ api / main / status | \
python -m json . tool
3 Dependingon your operating system or command shell, you may have to use double quotes in the
--data argument to curl.
12.7 Remote Control Plugin 117
4 http://stellarium.org/doc/head/remoteControlDoc.html
118 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
Alternatively, you may start the plugin through command line arguments. This is useful
for automated setups or when multiple instances are running on the same computer. To start
the instance as a server, use the --syncMode=server argument with the optional --syncPort
parameter to specify the port to listen on. To start a client instance, use --syncMode=client and
use --syncHost and --syncPort to specify the server to connect to.
In the settings window, you can also specify what should happen when the client loses the
connection to its server, and what to do when the server quits normally. You can choose between
12.8 Remote Sync Plugin 119
Do nothing: connection is lost and will not be re-established. Stellarium client keeps running in
whatever state it was, waiting for keyboard/mouse interaction.
Try reconnecting: Assume Stellarium is switched off on the server but may come back online
again, or assume some temporary network problem. Stellarium client just keeps running in
whatever state it was, but tries to reconnect.
Quit: Assume the server always runs until switched off at the end of operating hours. This is
intended for pure client screens without keyboards. When the server is shut down, assume
this is the end of the day, and exit Stellarium. An enclosing run script can then shutdown the
client computer before power is switched off with some main switch.
By default, the following things are synchronized:
• simulation time
• viewer location
• the selected object
• view direction
• current field of view
• all StelProperty-based settings except for GUI-related properties. This includes almost all
settings visible in the configuration dialogs such as projection type, sky and view options,
landscape settings, line colors, etc.
Because there is currently no full time synchronisation implemented, for the best results all
client computers should make sure their system clocks are set as close as possible to the server
computer’s clock (preferably a few milliseconds difference at most). This can be done for example
by using an NTP server.5 If all your Stellarium instances run on the same device, this is of course
not necessary.
It is also possible to exclude some state from being synchronized. On each client, the client
configuration GUI (Figure 12.7) allows to disable specific settings from being synchronized on this
client.
The lower part of this dialog allows you to fine-tune which named StelProperties (which hold
parts of the internal program state) should be excluded from synchronization. The configuration
dialog lists all available properties which usually have easy to understand names on the left side.
Highlight one or more properties which you don’t want synchronized and press the arrow button to
move them to the list of excluded properties.
For historic reasons there are two kinds of Properties: Actions (Boolean switches, for which
also hotkeys can be assigned) and (genuine) StelProperties. The latter have names indicating which
module they belong to and may have other data types (numbers, colors, . . . ). Note that the actions
frequently are just alias names of Boolean StelProperties, so in order to inhibit a certain property
from being synchronized, you must find both entries.
Properties of plugins will only be visible when the respective plugin has been enabled. When
a plugin has been disabled, its properties may vanish from the stored list of non-synchronized
properties.
Each client can have different settings. This could allow installations with several screens
where on one screen you show the constellation figures, another screen shows the distribution of
deep-sky objects in the same frame, and a third screen may show a close-up view of the currently
centered object. Or just show several sky cultures, or show the sky at different locations, . . . .
The names of all available StelProperties from which you might want to select a few to exclude
from synchronisation can also be found with a little scripting (see chapter 16). Open the script
console F12 and enter the following call:
5 Instructions
on how to use the public NTP server pool for the most common operating systems can be
found at http://www.pool.ntp.org/en/use.html.
120 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
core.output(core.getPropertyList());
Run the script and inspect the output tab. It may take a little guesswork to select the right names,
but the general structure of property names like <Module>.<Property> should help you to find
your way around.
Figure 12.8: Interface of Solar System Editor plugin: Configuration file tab
6 https://www.minorplanetcenter.net
122 Chapter 12. Interface Extensions
Figure 12.9: Interface of Solar System Editor plugin: Solar System tab
Figure 12.10: Interface of Solar System Editor plugin: Import data dialog
12.9 Solar System Editor Plugin 123
Figure 12.11: Interface of Solar System Editor plugin: Import data dialog — view after
downloading and parsing the MPC data.
13. Object Catalog Plugins
The Bright Novae plugin provides visualization of some bright novae in the Milky Way galaxy. If
enabled (see section 11.1), bright novae from the past will be presented in the sky at the correct
times. For example, set date and time to 30 August 1975, look at the constellation Cygnus to see
Nova Cygni 19751 (Fig. 13.1).
13.1.1 Section Novae in config.ini file
You can edit config.ini file by yourself for changes of the settings for the Bright Novae plugin –
just make it carefully!
1 http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/V1500_Cygni
126 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
ID Type Description
last_update string Date and time of last update
update_frequency_days int Frequency of updates, in days
updates_enable bool Enable updates of bright novae catalog from Internet
url string URL of bright novae catalog
For example, the record for Nova Cygni 1975 (V1500 Cyg) looks like:
" V1500 ␣ Cyg " :
{
" name " : " Nova ␣ Cygni ␣ 1975 " ,
" type " : " NA " ,
" maxMagnitude " : 1.69 ,
" minMagnitude " : 21 ,
" peakJD " : 2442655 ,
" m2 " : 2 ,
" m3 " : 4 ,
" m6 " : 32 ,
" m9 " : 263
" distance " : 6.36 ,
" RA " : " 21 h11m36 .6 s " ,
" Dec " : " 48 d09m02s "
},
Figure 13.2: Supernova 1604 (also known as Kepler’s Supernova, Kepler’s Nova or
Kepler’s Star)
Similar to the Historical Novae plugin (section 13.1), the Historical Supernovae plugin provides
visualization of bright historical supernovae (Fig. 13.2) from the table below. If enabled (see
section 11.1), bright supernovae from the past will be presented in the sky at the correct times. For
example, set date and time to 29 April 1006, and look at the constellation Lupus to see SN 1006A.
2 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_185
3 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1006
4 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1054
5 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1181
6 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1572
7 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1604
128 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
8 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Cassiopeia_A
9 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/S_Andromedae
10 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN1972e
11 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1987A
12 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_1993J
13 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/SN_2011fe
13.2 Historical Supernovae Plugin 129
In both images for light curves the maximum brightness is marked as day 0.
13.2.3 Section Supernovae in config.ini file
You can edit config.ini file by yourself for changes of the settings for the Historical Supernovae
plugin – just make it carefully!
ID Type Description
last_update string Date and time of last update
update_frequency_days int Frequency of updates, in days
updates_enable bool Enable updates of bright novae catalog from Internet
url string URL of bright novae catalog
130 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
For example, the record for SN 1604A (Kepler’s Supernova) looks like:
" 1604 A " :
{
" type " : " I " ,
" maxMagnitude " : -2 ,
" peakJD " : 2307190 ,
" alpha " : " 17 h30m36 .00 s " ,
" delta " : " -21 d29m00 .0 s " ,
" distance " : 14 ,
" note " : " Kepler ’ s ␣ Supernova "
},
13.3 Exoplanets Plugin 131
This plugin plots the position of stars with exoplanets. Exoplanets data is derived from “The
Extrasolar Planets Encyclopaedia”14 . List of potential habitable exoplanets and data about them
were taken from “The Habitable Exoplanets Catalog”15 by the Planetary Habitability Laboratory16 .
If enabled (see section 11.1), just click on the Exoplanet button on the bottom toolbar to
display markers for the stars with known exoplanets. You can then either click on such a marked
star or find the stars with exoplanets by their designation (e.g., 24 Sex) in the F3 dialog (see 4.5).
14 http://exoplanet.eu/
15 http://phl.upr.edu/projects/habitable-exoplanets-catalog
16 http://phl.upr.edu/home
17 http://lasp.colorado.edu/~bagenal/3720/CLASS6/6EquilibriumTemp.html
18 http://phl.upr.edu/projects/earth-similarity-index-esi
132 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
22 Note the typographical difference between Ægir and Aegir, the Norwegian transliteration. The same
name, with the spelling Aegir, has been attributed to one of Saturn’s satellites, discovered in 2004.
23 Ogmios is a name already attributed to an asteroid.
24 The original proposed name Leda is already attributed to an asteroid and to one of Jupiter’s satellites.
of the astrolabe.
Samh (υ And c) – Samh is named for A BU AL -Q ASIM ’A SBAGH IBN M UHAMMAD IBN AL -
S AMH AL -M AHRI (or Ibn al-Samh), a noted 11th century astronomer and mathematician in
the school of al Majriti in Cordova (Andalusia, now modern Spain).
Majriti (υ And d) – Majriti is named for A BU AL -Q ASIM AL -Q URTUBI AL -M AJRITI, a notable
mathematician, astronomer, scholar, and teacher in 10th century and early 11th century
Andalusia (modern Spain).
Libertas * (ξ Aql) – Libertas is Latin for liberty. Liberty refers to social and political freedoms,
and a reminder that there are people deprived of liberty in the world even today. The
constellation Aquila represents an eagle – a popular symbol of liberty.
Fortitudo * (ξ Aql b) – Fortitudo is Latin for fortitude. Fortitude means emotional and mental
strength in the face of adversity, as embodied by the eagle (represented by the constellation
Aquila).
All names with asterix mark (*) are modified based on the original proposals, to be consistent
with the IAU rules.
13.3.3 Section Exoplanets in config.ini file
You can edit config.ini file by yourself for changes of the settings for the Exoplanets plugin –
just make it carefully!
ID Type Description
last_update string Date and time of last update
update_frequency_hours int Frequency of updates, in hours
updates_enable bool Enable updates of exoplanets catalog from Inter-
net
url string URL of exoplanets catalog
flag_show_exoplanets_button bool Enable showing button of exoplanets on bottom
bar
distribution_enabled bool Enable distribution mode of display
timeline_enabled bool Enable timeline mode of display
habitable_enabled bool Enable habitable mode of display
enable_at_startup bool Enable displaying exoplanets at startup of the
plugin
exoplanet_marker_color R,G,B Color for marker of star with planetary system
habitable_exoplanet_marker_color R,G,B Color for marker of star with planetary system
with potential habitable exoplanets
temperature_scale string Temperature scale for equilibrium temperature
of exoplanets. Possible values: Kelvin, Celsius,
Fahrenheit. Default value: Celsius.
13.3 Exoplanets Plugin 135
This plugin plots the position of various pulsars, with object information about each one. Pulsar
data is derived from “The Australia Telescope National Facility Pulsar Catalogue” (Manchester
et al., 2005).
If enabled (see section 11.1), use the button to activate display of pulsars. The GUI
allows a few configuration options. You can also find a pulsar ( F3 ) by its designation (e.g., PSR
J0437-4715).
13.4.1 Section Pulsars in config.ini file
ID Type Description
last_update string Date and time of last update
update_frequency_days int Frequency of updates [days]
updates_enable bool Enable updates of pulsars catalog from Internet
url string URL of pulsars catalog
enable_at_startup bool Enable displaying of pulsars at startup of Stellarium
distribution_enabled bool Enable distribution mode for the pulsars
flag_show_pulsars_button bool Enable displaying pulsars button on toolbar
marker_color R,G,B Color for marker of the pulsars
glitch_color R,G,B Color for marker of the pulsars with glitches
use_separate_colors bool Use separate colors for different types of the pulsars
138 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
If enabled (see section 11.1), use the button to activate display of quasars. The GUI allows
a few configuration options. You can also find a quasar ( F3 ) by its designation (e.g., 3C 273).
13.5.1 Section Quasars in config.ini file
ID Type Description
last_update string Date and time of last update
update_frequency_days int Frequency of updates, in days
updates_enable bool Enable updates of quasars catalog from Internet
url string URL of quasars catalog
enable_at_startup bool Enable displaying of quasars at startup of Stellarium
distribution_enabled bool Enable distribution mode for the quasars
flag_show_quasars_button bool Enable displaying quasars button on toolbar
marker_color R,G,B Color for marker of the quasars
140 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
Figure 13.7: The 1833 Leonids replayed with the Meteor Showers plugin.
In contrast and extension of the random shooting stars feature of Stellarium (see section 18.6),
this plugin provides data for real meteor showers and a marker for each active and inactive radiant,
showing real information about its activity. If enabled (see section 11.1), just click on the Meteor
Showers button on the bottom toolbar to display markers for the radiants.
13.6.1 Terms
Meteor shower
A meteor shower is a celestial event in which a number of meteors are observed to radiate, or
originate, from one point in the night sky. These meteors are caused by streams of cosmic debris
called meteoroids entering Earth’s atmosphere at extremely high speeds on parallel trajectories.
Most meteors are smaller than a grain of sand, so almost all of them disintegrate and never hit
the Earth’s surface. Intense or unusual meteor showers are known as meteor outbursts and meteor
storms, which may produce greater than 1,000 meteors an hour.
Radiant
The radiant or apparent radiant of a meteor shower is the point in the sky from which (to a planetary
observer) meteors appear to originate. The Perseids, for example, are meteors which appear to
come from a point within the constellation of Perseus.
An observer might see such a meteor anywhere in the sky but the direction of motion, when
traced back, will point to the radiant. A meteor that does not point back to the known radiant for a
given shower is known as a sporadic and is not considered part of that shower.
Many showers have a radiant point that changes position during the interval when it appears.
For example, the radiant point for the Delta Aurigids drifts by more than a degree per night.
142 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
Population index
The population index indicates the magnitude distribution of the meteor showers. Values below
2.5 correspond to distributions where bright meteors are more frequent than average, while values
above 3.0 mean that the share of faint meteors is larger than usual.
13.6.2 Section MeteorShowers in config.ini file
You can edit config.ini file by yourself for changes of the settings for the Meteor Showers
plugin – just make it carefully!
ID Type Description
last_update string Date and time of last update
update_frequency_hours int Frequency of updates, in hours
updates_enable bool Enable updates of the meteor showers catalog from Internet
url string URL of the meteor showers catalog
flag_show_ms_button bool Enable showing button of the meteor showers on bottom
bar
flag_show_radiants bool Enable displaying markers for the radiants of the meteor
showers
flag_active_radiants bool Flag for displaying markers for the radiants of the active
meteor showers only
enable_at_startup bool Enable displaying meteor showers at starup plugin
show_radiants_labels bool Flag for displaying labels near markers of the radiants of
the meteor showers
font_size int Font size for label of markers of the radiants of the meteor
showers
colorARG R,G,B Color for marker of active meteor showers with generic
data
colorARR R,G,B Color for marker of active meteor showers with real data
colorIR R,G,B Color for marker of inactive meteor showers
13.6 Meteor Showers Plugin 143
Acknowledgements
This plugin was created as project of ESA Summer of Code in Space 201325 .
25 http://sophia.estec.esa.int/socis2013/?q=about
13.7 Navigational Stars Plugin 145
26 The
Nautical Almanac website – http://aa.usno.navy.mil/publications/docs/na.php
27 Rude
Starfinder 2102-D description and usage instruction – http://oceannavigation.blogspot.
ru/2008/12/rude-starfinder-2102-d.html
146 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
29 http://www.json.org/
148 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
13.8.4 Configuration
The plug-in’s configuration data is stored in Stellarium’s main configuration file.
30 http://celestrak.com/NORAD/elements/
31 http://www.tle.info/joomla/index.php
32 http://www.space-track.org/
13.9 ArchaeoLines Plugin 149
13.9.1 Introduction
In the archaeoastronomical literature, several astronomically derived orientation schemes are
prevalent. Often prehistorical and historical buildings are described as having been built with a
main axis pointing to a sunrise on summer or winter solstice. There can hardly be a better tool than
Scenery3D (see chapter 14) to investigate a 3D model of such a building, and this plugin has been
introduced in version 0.13.3 as a further tool in the archaeoastronomer’s toolbox (Zotti, 2016b).
When activated (see section 11.1), you can find a a tool bar button (in the shape of a
trilithon with the sun shining through it). Press this, or Ctrl + U , to display the currently selected
set of characteristical diurnal arcs.
70 70
65 65
60 60
55 55
50 50
45 45
40 40
35 35
30 30
25 25
Solstices, Equinoxes
20 20
Solar Crossquarters
15 15
Major Standstills
10 Minor Standstills 10
5 Zenith Passage 5
Nadir Passage
0 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 100 110 120 130 140 150 160 170 180
Figure 13.12: Rising azimuths of a few important events for sun and moon, and zenith and
nadir passages depending on geographic latitudes (vertical axis).
The principal relation between declinations δ , geographic latitude ϕ, and the rising azimuth A
is computed from
sin δ
cos A = − . (13.1)
cos ϕ
This formula does not take into account local horizon elevation nor atmospheric refraction nor
lunar parallax correction. The effect applied to characteristic declinations is shown graphically for
the present time (J2000.0) in figure 13.12. For example, in a latitude of 30◦ , an object which goes
through the zenith rises at azimuth 55◦ . Lunar major standstill risings occur at azimuths 56.7◦ and
123.5◦ , lunar minor standstill risings at azimuths 69◦ and 111◦ . The summer sun rises at 62.6◦ , the
winter sun at 117.3◦ . An object which goes through the nadir rises at 125◦ .
The blue lines seem to vanish at ϕ = 45◦ : while there are still objects going through the zenith
in higher latitudes, they are circumpolar and do not cross the horizon.
For the lunar events, there are two lines each drawn by the plugin, for maximum and minimum
distance of the moon. The lunar extreme declinations are computed taking horizon parallax effects
into account. For technical reasons however, the derived declinations are then used to draw small
circles of constant declinations on the sphere, without taking the change of lunar horizontal parallax
into account. Note that therefore the observed declination of the moon at the major standstill can
exceed the indicated limits if it is high in the sky. The main purpose of this plugin is however to
show an indication of the intersection of the standstill lines with the horizon.
It may be very instructive to let the time run quite fast and observe the declination line of
“current moon” swinging between its north and south limits each month. These limits grow and
shrink between the Major and Minor Standstills in the course of 18.6 years.
13.9 ArchaeoLines Plugin 151
The sun likewise swings between the solstices. Over centuries, the solstice declinations very
slightly move as well due to the slightly changing obliquity of the ecliptic.
sin(λT − λO )
q = arctan (13.2)
cos ϕO tan ϕT − sinϕO cos(λT − λO )
In addition, up to two vertical lines with arbitrary azimuth and custom label can be shown.
ID Type Default
enable_at_startup bool false
color_equinox float R,G,B 1.00,1.00,0.50
color_solstices float R,G,B 1.00,1.00,0.25
color_crossquarters float R,G,B 1.00,0.75,0.25
color_major_standstill float R,G,B 0.25,1.00,0.25
color_minor_standstill float R,G,B 0.20,0.75,0.20
color_zenith_passage float R,G,B 1.00,0.75,0.75
color_nadir_passage float R,G,B 1.00,0.75,0.75
color_selected_object float R,G,B 1.00,1.00,1.00
color_current_sun float R,G,B 1.00,1.00,0.75
color_current_moon float R,G,B 0.50,1.00,0.50
color_current_planet float R,G,B 0.25,0.80,1.00
color_geographic_location_1 float R,G,B 0.25,1.00,0.25
color_geographic_location_2 float R,G,B 0.25,0.25,1.00
color_custom_azimuth_1 float R,G,B 0.25,1.00,0.25
color_custom_azimuth_2 float R,G,B 0.25,0.50,0.75
33 Unfortunately,
on some systems with Windows in OpenGL mode, the color dialog hides behind the
Stellarium window when in fullscreen mode. So, before editing line colors, please leave fullscreen mode!
152 Chapter 13. Object Catalog Plugins
14.1 Introduction
Have you ever wished to be able to walk through Stonehenge or other ancient building structures de-
scribed as being constructed with astronomical orientation in mind, and experience such orientation
in a 3D virtual environment that also provides a good sky simulation?
The Stellarium Scenery3d plugin allows you to see architectural 3D models embedded in a
landscape combined with the excellent representation of the sky provided by Stellarium. You can
walk around, check for (or demonstrate) possible astronomical alignments of ancient architecture,
see sundials and other shadow casters in action, etc.
14.2 Usage
You activate the plugin with the circular enclosure button at screen bottom or by pressing
Ctrl + W . The other button with circular enclosure and tool icon (or Ctrl + + W ) opens
the settings dialog. Once loaded and displaying, you can walk around pressing Ctrl plus cursor
keys. Change eye height with Ctrl + Page / Ctrl + Page keys. Adding key increases speed
by 10, adding Alt multiplies by 5 (pressing both keys multiplies by 50!). If you release Ctrl before
the cursor key, animation will continue. (Press Ctrl +any cursor key to stop moving.)
Further key bindings exist which can be configured using the Stellarium default key-binding
interface. Some options are also available in the Scenery3d dialog. For example, coordinate display
can be enabled with Ctrl + R + T . If your models are georeferenced in a true geographical
coordinate grid, e.g. UTM or Gauss-Krueger, you will especially like this, and this makes the plugin
usable for scientific purposes. Display shows grid name, Easting, Northing, Altitude of ground, and
eye height above ground.
Other features include a virtual “torchlight”, which can be enabled with Ctrl + R + L to give
154 Chapter 14. Scenery3d – 3D Landscapes
additional local illumination around the viewer to help to see in the dark. Interesting points of view
can be saved and restored later by the user, including a description of the view. Scene authors can
also distribute predefined viewpoints in their scene.
The plugin also simulates the shadows of the scene’s objects cast by the Sun, Moon and even
Venus (only 1 shadow caster used at a time, you will never see shadows cast by Venus in moonlight),
so you could use it for examining sundials, or analyze and simulate light-and-shadow interactions
in archaeological structures.
Geometry Yes
Lights Yes
Clay No
Photomatched Yes
DefaultUVs No
Instanced No
does. All settings are saved automatically, and restored when you reopen Stellarium.
Another quirk has to be fixed manually though: in the material description file (MTL), TIG’s
exporter writes both d and Tr lines with the same value. Actually, Tr = 1.0 − d according to
OBJ/MTL documentation, so you should edit away one line, or else the later line overwrites the
value given earlier. Moreover, given that Tr=1 should actually specify fully transparent objects,
such a line will make your object entirely invisible!
Another (almost) working alternative: ObjExporter.rb by author Honing. Here, export with
settings 0xxx00. This will not create a TX... folder but dump all textures in the same directory as
the OBJ and MTL files. Unfortunately, currently some material assignments seem to be bad.
This also requires the landscape’s self-illumination layer to be enabled. It allows to model self-
illuminating objects such as street lights, windows etc. It can optionally also be modulated by the
emissive texture map_Ke.
If a value for Ks is specified, specularity is evaluated using the Phong reflection model4 with
Ns as the exponential shininess constant. Larger shininess means smaller specular highlights (more
metal-like appearance). Specularity is not modulated by the texture maps. Unfortunately, some 3D
editors export unusable default value combinations for Ks and Ns. Blender may create lines with
Ks=1/1/1 and Ns=0. This creates a look of “partial overexposed snow fields”. While the values are
allowed in the specification, in most cases the result looks ugly. Make sure to set Ns to 1 or higher,
or disable those two lines.
If a value for d or Tr exists, alpha blending is enabled for this material. This simulates
transparency effects. Transparency can be further controlled using the alpha channel of the map_Kd
texture.
A simpler and usually more performant way to achieve simple “cutout” transparency effects is
alpha-testing, by setting bAlphatest to 1. This simply discards all pixels of the model where the
alpha value of the map_Kd is below the transparency_threshold value from scenery3d.ini,
making “holes” in the model. This also produces better shadows for such objects. If required, alpha
testing can be combined with “real” blending-based transparency.
Sometimes, exported objects only have a single side (“paper wall”), and are only visible from
one side when looked at in Scenery3d. This is caused by an optimization called back-face culling,
which skips drawing the back sides of objects because they are usually not visible anyway. If
possible, avoid such “thin” geometry, this will also produce better shadows on the object. As a
workaround, you can also set bBackface to 1 to disable back-face culling for this material.
The optional map_bump enables the use of a tangent-space normal maps5 , which provides a
dramatic improvement in surface detail under illumination.
4 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Phong_reflection_model
5 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Normal_mapping
158 Chapter 14. Scenery3d – 3D Landscapes
obj_order=XYZ Use this if you have used an exporter which swaps Y/Z
coordinates. Defaults to XYZ, other options: XZY, YZX, YXZ,
ZXY, ZYX
camNearZ=0.3 This defines the distance of the camera near plane, default
0.3. Everything closer than this value to the camera can not
be displayed. Must be larger than zero. It may seem tempting
to set this very small, but this will lead to accuracy issues.
Recommendation is not to go under 0.1
camFarZ=10000 Defines the maximal viewing distance, default 10000.
shadowDistance=<val> The maximal distance shadows are displayed. If left out, the
value from camFarZ is used here. If this is set to a smaller
value, this may increase the quality of the shadows that are
still visible.
shadowSplitWeight=0..1 Decimal value for further shadow tweaking. If you require
better shadows up close, try setting this to higher values. The
default is calculated using a heuristic that incorporates scene
size.
[general]
These entries describe the offset, in metres, of the model coordinates relative to coordinates in a
geographic grid, like Gauss-Krüger or UTM. If you have your model vertices specified in grid
coordinates, do not specify orig_... data, but please definitely add start_... data, below.
Note that using grid coordinates without offset for the vertices is usually a bad idea for real-
world applications like surveyed sites in UTM coordinates. Coordinate values are often very large
numbers (ranging into millions of meters from equator and many thousands from the zone meridian).
If you want to assign millimetre values to model vertices, you will hit numerical problems with the
usual single-precision floating point arithmetic. Therefore we can specify this offset which is only
necessary for coordinate display.
Typically, digital elevation models and building structures built on those are survey-grid aligned,
so true geographical north for a place with geographical longitude λ and latitude ϕ will in general
not coincide with grid north, the difference is known as meridian convergence6 .
This amount can be given in convergence_angle (degrees), so that your model will be rotated
clockwise by this amount around the vertical axis to be aligned with True North7 .
grid_meridian is the central meridian λ0 of grid zone, e.g. for UTM or Gauss-Krüger, and is only
required to compute convergence angle if convergence_angle=from_grid.
6 http://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Transverse_Mercator_projection
7 Note
that Sketchup’s georeferencing dictionary provides a NorthAngle entry, which is 360 −
convergence_angle.
14.4 Model Configuration 161
correct transformation matrix. Importing the OBJ in Sketchup may take a long time for detailed
photo-generated models, and the texturing may suffer, so you can cut the model down to the
minimum necessary e.g. in Meshlab, and import just a stub required to georeference the model in
Sketchup.
Now, how would you find the proper orientation? The easiest chance would be with a structure
visible in the photo layer of Google Earth. So, start a new model and immediately add location
from the Google Earth interface. Then you can import the OBJ with TIG’s importer plugin. If
the imported model looks perfect, you may just place the model into the Sketchup landscape and
export a complete landscape just like above. If not, or if you had to cut/simplify the OBJ to be
able to import it, you can rotate/scale the OBJ (it must be grouped!). If you see a shadow in the
photos, you may want to set the date/time of the original photos in the scene and verify that the
shadows created by Sketchup illuminating the model match those in the model’s photo texture.
When you are satisfied with placement/orientation, you create a scenery3d.ini like above with
the command Plugins ASTROSIM/Stellarium scenery3d helpers Create scenery3d.ini .
Then, you select the OBJ group, open the Windows Ruby Console and readout data by calling
Plugins ASTROSIM/Stellarium scenery3d helpers Export transformation of selected group .
On the Ruby console, you will find a line of numbers (the 4 × 4 transformation matrix) which
you copy/paste (all in one line!) into the [model] section in scenery3d.ini.
obj2grid_trafo = < a11 > , < a12 > , < a13 > , < a14 > , < a21 > , < a22 > , < a23 > , < a24 > ,
<a31 > , < a32 > , < a33 > , < a34 > , < a41 > , < a42 > , < a43 > , < a44 >
You edit the scenery3d.ini to use your full (unmodified) PhotoFly model and, if you don’t have a
panorama, take Zero Horizon landscape as (no-)background. It depends on the model if you want
to be able to step on it, or to declare ground=NULL for a constant-height ground. Run Stellarum
once and adjust the start_N, start_E and zero_ground_height.
; an example for a second entry ( note the 2 at the beginning of each line !)
2/ label = Signs
2/ description = Two signs that describe the Sterngarten
2/ position = 593155.2421 ,5333348.6304 ,325.7295809038 ,0.8805
2/ view_fov = 84.315399 , -8.187078 ,83.000000
14.6 Example
Let us add a quick example here. A recent paper (Pollard, 2017) claims that the Uffington White
Horse, a geoglyph carved into a hillsite in England during the Bronze Age, may depict the mythical
“Sun Horse”, a common conception of that period.
Unfortunately, as of 2017, the official UK Lidar repository does not include the Uffington
area, so a detailed GIS-based model is not available. We could use EUdem25 data with aerial
imagery, or for a quick look, we just use Sketchup. Yet another unfortunate development: Trimble
declared that after the 5-year transition period from Google to Trimble is over in May 2017, terrain
modelling will be limited to Sketchup Pro. But note that a fresh installation comes with a 30-day
Pro trial time, this should be enough for this example.
First, locate the site in Google Earth at λ = −1.56718, ϕ = 51.582843. (Or just search for
“Uffington”.) Try to identify which parts of the landscape may be visible from your site, so you
can estimate which parts of terrain should be included in the model. Open Sketchup, select the
meter-based “Landscape Architecture” template, add View Toolbars. . . : Locations. Click on the
“Add Location” button of that toolbar. Enter “Uffington” into the location search dialog. This brings
you close to our site of interest. Clip a part of terrain to import it to Sketchup. Optionally, add more
terrain.
If installed, TIG’s OBJ exporter is available from the File menu, or you can use Sketchup Pro’s
built-in OBJ export. Export UffingtonHorse.obj to a subdirectory scenery3d/Uffington in
your Stellarium user data directory. The geolocation is stored in an “AttributeDictionary”. To read
this, press Window Ruby Console to open the Ruby Console. Then write a few lines of Ruby to
get access to the Georeference dictionary and other data:
Note the ModelTranslation values. Those are inches (of all units!) in the UTM reference
frame and define the model coordinate origin in world coordinates. (Actually, it uses the negative
values.) Multiplication by 2.54 gives cm, and by 0.0254, meters in the UTM coordinate system. We
will use the negatives of these values as orig_E, orig_N, orig_H. Additionally, we have found
information about meridian convergence correction (Sketchup’s NorthAngle), UTM zone number
etc. All this goes into our configuration file. Create this file scenery3d.ini with the content seen
in fig. 14.1
164 Chapter 14. Scenery3d – 3D Landscapes
[ model ]
name = UffingtonHorse
; Either a fitting landscape or just ’ Zero Horizon ’:
landscape = Zero Horizon
scenery = UffingtonHorse . obj
; activate the next line if you have a separate ground layer
; ground = UffingtonHorse_ground . obj
; If model Y - axis points up , activate the next line
; obj_order = XZY
author = Georg Zotti
copyright =( c ) 2017 Georg Zotti
description = Uffington Horse may represent the Sun Horse . \
See Joshua Pollard in Antiquity 91 356(2017): 406 -20.
[ location ]
name = UffingtonHorse
country = UK
planetName = Earth
; Set the following to a fitting landscape
landscapeKey = Zero Horizon
longitude = -1.56718254089355
latitude =51.5828432749823
altitude =137
[ coord ]
grid_name = UTM 30 U ( WGS 84)
gridType = UTM
orig_E =599273.02119578
orig_N =5715615.15079106
orig_H =136.295297626736
convergence_angle =1.12284363771988
; Height used outside the terrain , to not " fall ␣ off " the rim .
zero_ground_height =137
; You may want to reset these coordinates .
; Observer is set to those on loading the scenery .
start_E =599273.02119578
start_N =5715615.15079106
start_az_alt_fov =50 ,10 ,83
10 http://astrosim.univie.ac.at
15. Stellarium at the Telescope
Stellarium is great for indoor use on the desktop, but it is also very useful outdoors under the real
sky, and several plugins enhance its usability particularly for observers.
Two plugins are bundled with Stellarium which are designed to be used at the telescope:
Oculars (section 15.1), which provides field of view hints for telescopes, oculars and sensors, and
TelescopeControl (section 15.2), which allows you to send GOTO commands to many motorized
telescope mounts. Other GOTO telescopes are supported by external programs which you must
install separately: StellariumScope (section 15.5), RTS2 (section 15.3) or INDI (section 15.4). This
can also help DIY hardware tinkerers who like to build their own control systems (section 15.6).
In addition, the Observability plugin (section 15.7) can be used for planning the best times to
observe your favourite objects.
Figure 15.1: The on-screen menu (top right) and popup menu (lower right) of the Oculars
plugin.
Telrad Finder
The Telrad view can be used without defining any of the items below. As a reflex sight is non-
magnifying, this feature can only be enabled when no eyepiece is selected. You still may want to
zoom in a bit to better see which stars are in the circles (fig. 15.2). The three circles that appear in
the center of the screen are 0.5◦ , 2.0◦ , and 4.0◦ in diameter. They stay centered in the screen, so
move the “telescope” (click-drag the background) to center the circles on the object of interest.
While the Telrad finder is active, you can not activate a CCD with the popup menu, but only
with the on-screen menu.
Figure 15.2: The left image is the default 60◦ , and the right one is 40◦ .
15.1 Oculars Plugin 169
CCD Sensors
Figure 15.3: View of M37 through a CCD sensor of the Oculars plugin.
Figure 15.4: View of M37 through a CCD sensor of the Oculars plugin (without on-screen
control panel).
This is a great way to get an idea of what a particular camera will be able to capture when attached
to a particular telescope or lens. For using camera lenses, you must describe them as telescope with
the appropriate values for the lens. When active, this feature will display a red bounding box of the
area that will be captured, as well as zoom in to give a better view of the surroundings. You can
manually zoom in or out from there.
The default CCD view will appear similar to fig. 15.3 or, when you are working without the
on-screen control panel, the information area in the upper right hand corner also shows angular size
captured by the CCD (see fig. 15.4).
When a CCD view is displayed, the popup menu changes as seen in fig. 15.5. You can select
what telescope to use, as well as progress to the previous or next CCD, or go to a specific CCD.
You can also rotate the CCD to better frame your subject, or to see if the CCD can be rotated in
such a way as to catch your area of interest (see fig. 15.6). Once rotated, the CCD frame on screen
displays the new orientation (see fig. 15.7).
170 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
Figure 15.5: The CCD sensor popup menu of the Oculars plugin.
Oculars
• Define some eyepieces and telescope (see section 15.1.2).
• Select an object to view (i.e. a star, planet, etc.)
• Click the toolbar button for toggling the Ocular view, or press Ctrl + O ( + O for
Mac users).
• Swap between eye pieces and telescopes to see how the view changes.
This is really the area of interest to most telescopic observers. It is a great way to compare
different eyepiece/telescope combinations, to see how they change the view of the sky. And it is
easy to do so with binoculars too. To show this, let us use the M37 cluster as target. Through a pair
of Celestron 15x70 binoculars, it would look like in fig. 15.8.
A very pretty sight. Now, what would it look like through a Celestron 80 mm EDF finder ’scope,
with an Explore Scientific 14 mm 100◦ eyepiece? See fig. 15.9!
Figure 15.9: The M37 cluster through a Celestron 80 mm EDF with Explore Scientific
14 mm eyepiece.
Not bad at all. But we like to see more! So we move the eyepiece to a C1400. See fig. 15.10 for the
resulting view.
172 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
Figure 15.10: The M37 cluster through a Celestron C1400 with Tele Vue Nagler 31 mm
eyepiece.
Very nice indeed! So for this target, the C1400 is going to be the best bet. However, if my
target was the Pleiades, the C1400 with that eyepiece would not be good – the 80EDF would do
much better!
When an eyepiece is active, the popup menu again changes. With a non-binocular eyepiece
selected, you also have the ability to select a particular eyepiece or telescope. When a binocular is
active, you can not select a telescope, as it is not relevant. Changing the eyepiece to a non-binocular
will again allow the telescope to be selected. Also notice that when your mouse cursor is very near
the right hand border of the screen, the popup menu’s sub-menus display to the left, not the right.
15.1.2 Configuration
All configuration is done through the user interface in the application. To open the configuration
dialog hit the Alt + O key, or click the configure button on the plugin setup dialog (available
in the Plugins tab of Stellarium’s Configuration window (opened by pressing F2 or the
button in the left toolbar)), or the rightmost button of the on-screen panel (if displayed in the top
right corner of screen). There are six tabs in the configuration dialog: General, Eyepieces, Lenses,
Sensors, Telescopes, and About. The first five are the ones we are interested in here.
1 The appearance of stars may depend on various other factors: telescope type, ocular type, quality of
optics, seeing, . . . Such details with all combinations cannot meaningfully be stored, though. These values
should allow a rapid toggle on any single night.
15.1 Oculars Plugin 173
General
The first option allows you to define the general behaviour of the plugin. The options are grouped
by areas of usage: Interface, Ocular view, Sensor view and Telrad view (see figure 15.11).
Interface: this group of options allows to change behaviour of the plugin in general.
On-screen control panel: show an additional GUI panel in the top-right corner of the
screen to allow switching features of the plugin (in addition to the popup window).
Restore FOV to initial values and
Restore direction to initial values options allow restoration field of view and direction of
view, resp., to the initial values at program start at the end of the plugin usage (e.g.,
when disabling the view through CCD frame).
Show resolution criteria compute and show Rayleigh criterion, Dawes’, Abbe’s and Spar-
row’s limits for combination of telescope, lens and eyepiece. In addition, this option
will show visual resolution for selected “setup”. This option may be very helpful for
double star observers.
Show oculars button on toolbar option allows to toggle visibility the plugin button on v0.19.0
main toolbar.
Arrow button scale allows to change the size of the arrow buttons in the ocular GUI panel.
Ocular view is a group of options that allows to change the plugin’s behaviour in visual observation
mode.
Enable only if an object is selected – uncheck this option if you want to use the visual
observation mode when no object is selected.
Limit stellar magnitude allows to hide faint stars, which are invisible for the selected
combination of eyepiece, lens and telescope.
Hide grids and lines when enabled allows to hide grids and lines when you observe the
sky through the eyepiece and re-enables their visibility when leaving visual observation
mode.
Scale image circle option allows you to define whether or not to scale the images based on
apparent FOV. When deactivated, the image circle will fill your screen. In general,
we recommend you not select this, unless you have a need to, because it can really
174 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
reduce the image size on the screen. It can however be very useful in comparing
two eyepieces. If you set this option, the on-screen image will be scaled based on
the eyepieces and telescopes you define. See section 15.1.3 for information on what
scaling means, and why you might want to use it.
Use semi-transparent mask: uncheck this option if you want to see visible field of view
as in real telescope.
Sensor view is group of options allows to change behaviour of the plugin for photographic
observations mode.
Use degrees and minutes for FOV of CCD – for many cases the use of decimal degrees
for the value of the field of view is not comfortable, and this option allows to use the
more human readable format for FOV.
Enable automatic switch of mount type allows to store the CCD frame orientation when
the type of telescope mount is changed.
v0.19.0 Show sensor crop overlay option toggle drawing a crop box within the CCD frame.
v0.19.0 Telrad view is a group of options which allows to change behaviour of the plugin for Telrad mode.
Enable scaling FOV for Telrad option allows you to define whether or not to scale the
Telrad circles to half of apparent FOV. When activated, the Telrad circles will fill your
screen.
Eyepieces
This is the tab used to enter your own eyepieces (see figures 15.12 and 15.13). By default, a few
sample ones have been added; feel free to delete those once you’ve entered your own.
The fields on this tab are:
Name – a free-text description of the eye piece. You could modify this to match your personal
descriptions of eyepieces.
aFOV – apparent field of view in degrees.
Focal Length – eyepiece focal length in mm.
Field Stop – the field stop of the eyepiece in mm. This is used to calculate the true field of view of
an eyepiece. If you do not know what it is just leave it the default zero. Not all manufacturers
provide this value; TeleVue is one that does.
Binoculars – selecting this checkbox tells the system that this eyepiece is binoculars or finders;
this means that this eyepiece can be used without defining a telescope.
Has permanent cross-hairs – selecting this checkbox tells the system that this eyepiece or binoc-
ular (finder) has also simple cross-hairs2 .
When Binoculars are described, the relevant fields change to
tFOV – true field of view in degrees.
Magnification factor – the magnification of the binocular.
Diameter – the diameter of the binocular objective in mm.
Lenses
This is the tab used to enter your own lenses (see figure 15.14). By default, a few sample ones have
been added; feel free to delete them once you’ve entered your own.
The fields on this tab are:
Name – a free-text description of the lense. You could modify this to match your personal
descriptions of lenses.
Multiplier – a factor larger than 1 expands the focal length, and lenses with this type are named
Barlow lense; a factor less than 1 reduces the focal length, and lenses with this type are
2 The Oculars plugin supports eyepieces with reticle patterns – both special eyepieces are available in the
default list of eyepieces, and the option Has permanent cross-hairs is not related to those eyepieces.
15.1 Oculars Plugin 175
Figure 15.13: Eyepieces tab of Oculars plugin configuration dialog (settings for binocular).
176 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
Sensors
This tab allows you to define sensors for any camera you may have (see figure 15.15). When defined
and selected, this will draw a red bounding rectangle in the center of the eye piece view, showing
what the CCD will capture. Because of the way floating point numbers are stored, sometimes you
may see one of your defined values change (for example from 2.2 to 2.19999) but this should not
affect what you see.
Telescopes
This is the tab used to enter your own telescopes (see fig. 15.16). The fields on this tab are:
Different eyepieces generally have a different apparent field of view (aFOV). An easy way
to think about this is: the larger the aFOV, the bigger the picture you see in the eyepiece. Older
types of eyepiece (some types still built and in wide use today have been constructed in the 19th
century) generally have their aFOV in the 50◦ range. Today, there are massive eyepieces available
with 82◦ , and recently even 100◦ aFOV! These eyepieces are huge, as they require a lot of very
special glass to achieve their incredible fields of view. An eyepiece of the same focal length with a
100◦ aFOV will produce an image through the eyepiece that is twice as wide as one produced by a
50◦ eyepiece.
Different telescopes, with an eyepiece of a given aFOV, will also produce a different true field
of view. This is the actual size of the piece of sky that you see through the eyepiece. Getting these
two “just right” can be very important. It’s easy to assume that you want the biggest telescope
you can get, with the eyepiece that gives you the highest magnification. This is never true in
reality. Depending on where you live, and especially what you like to look at, a 100-120 mm quality
refractor with a wide aFOV eyepiece may very well be better than a large SCT with the same
eyepiece. This is something I learned the hard way.
So how does scaling the eyepiece view help? The plugin will find the eyepiece you have with
the largest aFOV. This aFOV becomes 100% of the computer screen diameter. Then, any other
eyepiece will have its aFOV compared, and the view on screen will be scaled down accordingly.
These 100◦ aFOV eyepieces makes the math here easy. If you have one, then when that eyepiece
is used, the circle that represents the view through the eyepiece will take up 100% of the screen
diameter. Next, if you select an eyepiece with an 82◦ aFOV, its view will be scaled to 82% of the
screen, and a 62◦ aFOV eyepiece will be scaled to 62% of the screen.
Example in action
This is easier to understand in action, so let us look at an example that uses three eyepieces all with
the same 17 mm focal length, so they all produce the same level of magnification (well, one has
an 17.3 mm focal length, but its magnification is nearly identical) and see how the view changes.
These example all use a Celestron C8 8" SCT telescope, and the target is the Great Orion Nebula.
We can see from the images in fig. 15.17 that the target is all three images is the same size.
The 100◦ image fills the screen, the 82◦ is smaller, and the 62◦ is smallest yet, filling 62% of the
computer screen. Note that in each image, the field of view that you see changes. The larger the
aFOV, the more you can see of the sky. So in this example, if you had an 8" telescope, you would
want to use the 17 mm 100◦ Ethos eyepiece to see as much of the nebula as possible.
15.1 Oculars Plugin 179
Figure 15.17: Comparing apparent fields of view of (top) a 17 mm Tele Vue Ethos eyepiece
with an aFOV of 100◦ . Magnification is 119.5×. (center) a 17 mm Tele Vue Nagler
eyepiece with an aFOV of 82◦ . Magnification is 119.5×. (bottom) a 17.3 mm Tele Vue
Delos eyepiece with an aFOV of 62◦ . Magnification is 117.5×.
180 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
WARNING
Stellarium cannot prevent your telescope from being pointed at the Sun. It is up to you to ensure
proper filtering and safety measures are applied!
Never point your telescope at the Sun without a proper solar filter installed. The powerful light
amplified by the telescope WILL cause irreversible damage to your eyes and/or your equipment.
Even if you don’t do it deliberately, a slew during daylight hours may cause your telescope to
point at the sun on its way to the given destination, so it is strongly recommended to avoid using
the telescope control feature before sunset without appropriate protection.
• By pressing the Configure telescopes... button in the Slew to window (opened by pressing
Ctrl + 0 or the respective button on the bottom toolbar).
The Telescopes tab displays a list of the telescope connections that have been set up:
• The number (#) column shows the number used to control this telescope. For example, for
telescope #2, the shortcut is Ctrl + 2 .
• The Status column indicates if this connection is currently active or not. Unfortunately, there
are some cases in which ’Connected’ is displayed when no working connection exists.
• The Type field indicates what kind of connection this is:
virtual means a virtual telescope (test mode).
local, Stellarium means a DIRECT connection to the telescope (see above).
local, external means an INDIRECT connection to a program running on the same com-
puter.
remote, unknown means an INDIRECT connection over a network to a remote machine.
remote, RTS2 means an INDIRECT connection over a network to an RTS2 server.
remote, INDI means an INDIRECT connection over a network to an INDI server.
To set up a new telescope connection, press the Add button. To modify the configuration of an
existing connection, select it in the list and press the Configure button. In both cases, a telescope
connection configuration window will open.
Telescope properties
Name is the label that will be displayed on the screen next to the telescope reticle.
Connection delay If the movement of the telescope reticle on the screen is uneven, you can try
increasing or decreasing this value.
Coordinate system Some Celestron telescopes have had their firmware updated and now interpret
the coordinates they receive as coordinates that use the equinox of the date (EOD, also
known as JNow), making necessary this setting.
Start/connect at startup Check this option if you want Stellarium to attempt to connect to the
telescope immediately after it starts. Otherwise, to start the telescope, you need to open the
main window, select that telescope and press the Start/Connect button.
Device settings
This section is active only for DIRECT connections (see above).
Serial port sets the serial port used by the telescope. There is a pop-up box that suggests some
default values:
• On Windows, serial ports COM1 to COM10
• On Linux, serial ports /dev/ttyS0 to /dev/ttyS3 and USB ports /dev/ttyUSB0 to
/dev/ttyUSB3. Make sure you have read/write access to the tty device. Depending
on your flavour of Linux, this may e.g. require some group membership.
• On Mac OS X, the list is empty as it names its ports in a peculiar way. If you are using
182 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
an USB cable, the default serial port of your telescope most probably is not in the list
of suggestions. To list all valid serial port names in Mac OS X, open a terminal and
type:
ls / dev /*
This will list all devices, the full name of your serial port should be somewhere in the
list (for example, /dev/cu.usbserial-FTDFZVMK).
Device model : see 15.2.5 Supported devices.
Connection settings
Both fields here refer to INDIRECT connections, which implies communication over a network
(TCP/IP).
Host can be either a host name or an IPv4 address such as ’127.0.0.1’. The default value of
’localhost’ means ’this computer’.
Modifying the default host name value makes sense only if you are attempting a remote
connection over a network. In this case, it should be the name or IP address of the computer
that runs a program that runs the telescope.
Port refers to the TCP port used for communication. The default value depends on the telescope
number and ranges between 10001 and 10009.
RTS2 settings
v0.16.0 (see also 15.3) You will need access to an RTS2 HTTPD server through HTTP/JSON calls. Please
see RTS2 documentation (man rts2-httpd) for details. You will as well need username and password
for HTTPD. Please be aware that in order to move the telescope, your user must have the telescope
in the list of allowed devices in the database. Please see man rts2-user for details on how to
manipulate RTS2 users.
URL points to RTS2 HTTPD. Can include anything a URL can have - port (:8889) and prefix path
for RTS2 access.
Username username used for login to RTS2 HTTPD.
Password password for login to RTS2 HTTPD.
INDI settings
v0.17.0 (see also 15.4) You will need access to an INDI server through a TCP/IP connection. Please see
INDI documentation for details. You will need to select the correct INDI device to manage it.
Pressing the Slew button slews the selected device to the selected set of coordinates. See the
section about keyboard commands below for other ways of controlling the device.
Pressing the Configure telescopes. . . button opens the main window of the plug-in.
TIP: Inside the ’Slew’ window, underlined letters indicate that pressing Alt + underlined letter
can be used instead of clicking. For example, pressing Alt + S is equivalent to clicking the Slew
button, pressing Alt + E switches to decimal degree format, etc.
Sending commands
Once a telescope is successfully started/connected, Stellarium displays a telescope reticle labelled
with the telescope’s name on its current position in the sky. The reticle is an object like every other
in Stellarium - it can be selected with the mouse, it can be tracked and it appears as an object in the
’Search’ window.
To point a device to an object: Select an object (e.g. a star) and press the number of the device
while holding down the Ctrl key. (For example, Ctrl + 1 for telescope #1.) This will move the
telescope to the selected object. Note that most telescopes can only execute a single command
to move to that object’s position, but if the telescope is an RTS2 telescope, you can even track a
satellite (if the mount then is fast enough to support it).4
To point a device to the center of the view: Press the number of the device while holding down
the Alt key. (For example, Alt + 1 for telescope #1.) This will slew the device to the point in
the center of the current view. (If you move the view after issuing the command, the target won’t
change unless you issue another command.)
To point a device to a given set of coordinates: Use the Slew to window (press Ctrl + 0 ).
Virtual telescope
If you want to test this plug-in without an actual device connected to the computer, choose “Nothing,
just simulate one (a moving reticle)” in the Telescope controlled by: field. It will show a telescope
reticle that will react in the same way as the reticle of a real telescope controlled by the plug-in.
See the section above about field of view indicators for a possible practical application (emulating
’Telrad’ circles).
15.3 RTS2
v0.16.0 RTS2, the Remote Telescope System 2, is a complete robotic observatory control system for Linux
by Petr Kubánek, who kindly provided the plugin code to make RTS2 interoperate with Stellarium.
We cannot give a full manual or any further support for RTS2 here, please refer to its website7 for
complete instructions about dome control, cameras, filter wheels, weather sensors, etc. A few notes
may be useful for beginners, though.
RTS2’s central piece is a daemon. Start the system:
sudo service rts2 start
RTS2’s main control screen is text-based, rts2-mon. For a quick check, switch on the system using
F9 . Telescope T0 is a dummy telescope which you can select and operate with commands like
move 120 35 (this moves to RA=120◦ =8h, DEC=35◦ , but only when this position is above your
horizon).
Stellarium’s Telescope plugin can communicate with RTS2 using the RTS2 web interface. You
must run rts2-httpd for this, which may require the right permissions to write the lock files in
/var/run. This program requires that a database has been created as described in the file RUN in
RTS2’s source directory and on the RTS2 website8 . Also, you must create a ’user’ for RTS2. This
is not a regular Linux account, but an entry in the RTS2 database. Create a user with rts2-user -a
<user>. You should use a password different from your regular Linux password, as this will be
transmitted in plain text between the computer running Stellarium and the RTS2 control computer,
and may also be written into Stellarium’s logfile. Then you can enable device control for the
respective user. If you want to send slew commands from Stellarium, make sure to allow access to
telescope T0. If not, Stellarium will be able to show the telescope marker, but you will not be able
to control the telescope. To enable control for existing users in the default stars database,
5 http://rts2.org/
6 http://indilib.org
7 http://rts2.org
8 http://rts2.org/faq.html
15.4 INDI 185
psql stars
update users set allowed_devices = ’* ’;
In case you cannot properly connect to the RTS2 telescope or cannot send slew commands,
check Stellarium’s logfile log.txt for some diagnostic messages.
RTS2 is the only type of telescope supported by Stellarium which can autonomously track
satellites. Tracking accuracy fully depends on Stellarium’s TLE satellite elements being up-to-date
(see section 13.8) and the accuracy of your RTS2 installation.
15.4 INDI
INDI, the Instrument Neutral Distributed Interface, is a distributed control system (DCS) protocol v0.17.0
to enable control, data acquisition and exchange among hardware devices and software front ends,
emphasizing astronomical instrumentation9 .
INDI client (v1.6.0) has been incorporated into Stellarium’s Telescope Control plugin by
Alessandro Siniscalchi to allow Stellarium to communicate with INDI hardware drivers via INDI
server. INDI server is a hub that sits between drivers and clients. It reroutes traffic for control
and data across distributed networks. Each device or client in the network is a node and may
communicate with other nodes whenever desired. The server supports broadcasting, chaining, and
marshalling of data.
Stellarium only supports INDI mounts (no other INDI devices), and you will need to select the
correct INDI device to manage it at the stage of configuration of telescope. For this purpose the
plug-in has a tool to getting the list of connected devices from the INDI server (when the server is
working!). Please define hostname and port10 in the “INDI Settings” block, press Refresh devices
and select the required device in the list “Devices”.
List of telescope types supported by INDI11 :
• Meade Autostar
• Meade LX200 (Classic/GPS/16)
• Celestron NexStar
• Celestron NexStar Evolution
• Orion Synscan Telescope
• EQ-6 MCU Update
• HEQ-5 MCU Update
• LittleFoot Vpower
• LittleFoot Elegance Photo
• Astro-Electronic FS-2
• EQMod
• Pulsar2
• SkySensor2000PC
• Takahashi Temma
• 10 Micron
• Losmandy Gemini
• Astrophysics
• Skywatcher Virtuoso (Alt/Az)
• IOptron IEQPro/CEM60
9 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Instrument_Neutral_Distributed_Interface
10 The Internet Assigned Numbers Authority (IANA) has assigned to INDI the Transmission Control
Protocol and User Datagram Protocol (TCP/UDP) port 7624.
11 http://indilib.org/devices/telescopes/all.html
186 Chapter 15. Stellarium at the Telescope
• IOptron ZEQ25/SmartEQ
• IOptron GotoNova Upgrade Kit 8400
15.5 StellariumScope
StellariumScope is a free add-on that enables you to control your telescope with Stellarium.
Features
• Provides an interface between Stellarium and ASCOM telescope drivers.
• Provides the ability to both “Sync” and “Slew” the telescope. It’s also possible to issue a
stop/cancel command from Stellarium.
• You can easily host Stellarium on one computer linked to another control computer that
hosts the telescope driver.
• The installation program will automatically install the documentation, but the link to the
documentation is provided by developer12 so you can read it before installation.
• There are earlier releases still available on the downloads page on Welsh Dragon Computing
site.
The original StellariumScope program was designed and implemented by Scott of ByteArts
and is still available for download13 . If you have difficulties with the releases available on the Welsh
Dragon Computing site14 , you may want to consider using the original version.
Figure 15.18 shows the interface and some of the options. Use this application (like all software
that controls your mount) with supervision of your mount’s movements.
about-stellariumscope
15 https://sourceforge.net/p/stellarium/discussion/278769/thread/16e4c054/
?limit=25#8ffa
15.6 Other telescope servers and Stellarium 187
This Plugin is activated with the button . It analyzes the observability of the selected object (or
the screen center, if no object is selected). The plugin can show rise, transit, and set times, as well
as the best epoch of the year (i.e., largest angular separation from the Sun), the date range when
the source is above the horizon at dark night, and the dates of Acronychal and Cosmical rise/set.
Ephemerides of the Solar-System objects and parallax effects are taken into account.
mere input of a twilight Sun elevation by the user) will be implemented in future versions of
this plugin.
Full Moon When the Moon is selected, the program can compute the exact closest dates of the
Moon’s opposition to the Sun.
Note on Terminology
The (sparse) literature on terminology about computing these Heliacal, Acronychal or Cosmic
events seems to disagree on which end of the night is to be computed. While all agree about Heliacal
rises taking place in the morning, Acronychal and Cosmic are sometimes applied in reverse order
from those described here. In case you use these data, make sure you keep this definition as well.
Author
This plugin has been contributed by Ivan Marti-Vidal (Onsala Space Observatory)16 with some
advice by Alexander Wolf and Georg Zotti.
16 mailto:i.martividal@gmail.com
16. Scripting
16.1 Introduction
The development of a powerful scripting system has been continuing for a number of years now
and can now be called operational. The use of a script was recognised as a perfect way of arranging
a display of a sequence of astronomical events from the earliest versions of Stellarium and a simple
system called Stratoscript was implemented. The scripting facility is Stellarium’s version of a
Presentation, a feature that may be used to run an astronomical or other presentation for instruction
or entertainment from within the Stellarium program. The original Stratoscript was quite limited in
what it could do so a new Stellarium Scripting System has been developed.
Since version 0.10.1, Stellarium has included a scripting feature based on the Qt Scripting
Engine1 . This makes it possible to write small programs within Stellarium to produce automatic
presentations, set up custom configurations, and to automate repetitive tasks.
As of version 0.14.0 a new scripting engine has reached a level where it has all required features
for usage, however new commands may be added from time to time. Since version 0.14.0 support
of scripts for the Stratoscript engine has been discontinued.
The programming language ECMAscript2 (also known as JavaScript) gives users access to all
basic ECMAScript language features such as flow control, variables, string manipulation and so on.
Interaction with Stellarium-specific features is done via a collection of objects which represent
components of Stellarium itself. The various modules of Stellarium, and also activated plugins, can
be called in scripts to calculate, move the scene, switch on and off display of objects, etc. You can
write text output into text files with the output() command. You can call all public slots which
are documented in the scripting API documentation3 .
1 http://doc.qt.io/qt-5/qtscript-index.html
2 https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/ECMAScript
3 http://www.stellarium.org/doc/0.19.1/scripting.html
192 Chapter 16. Scripting
16.3 Includes
Stellarium provides a mechanism for splitting scripts into different files. Typical functions or lists
of variables can be stored in separate .inc files and used within other scripts through the include()
command:
include("common_objects.inc");
Figure 16.1: Retrograde motion of Mars in 2005. (Credit & Copyright: Tunc Tezel — APOD:
2006 April 22 – Z is for Mars.)
elsewhere! The description may cover several lines (until the end of the commented header) and
should therefore be the last entry of the header.
//
// Name: Retrograde motion of Mars
// Author: John Doe
// License: Public Domain
// Version: 1.0
// Shortcut: Ctrl+M
// Description: A demo of retrograde motion of Mars.
//
}
OK, Stellarium is doing something, but what exactly is it doing? The ground and atmosphere is
enabled and any motion of Mars is invisible. Let’s add an another few lines into the script (hiding
the landscape and atmosphere) after setting date and time:
LandscapeMgr.setFlagLandscape(false);
LandscapeMgr.setFlagAtmosphere(false);
The whole sky is moving now — let’s lock it! Add this line after previous lines:
StelMovementMgr.setFlagLockEquPos(true);
It looks better now, but what about cardinal points, elements of GUI and some “glitch of
movement”? Let’s change the script:
core.setDate("2009−10−01T10:00:00");
LandscapeMgr.setFlagCardinalsPoints(false);
LandscapeMgr.setFlagLandscape(false);
LandscapeMgr.setFlagAtmosphere(false);
core.setGuiVisible(false);
core.moveToRaDec("08h44m41s", "+18d09m13s",1);
StelMovementMgr.setFlagLockEquPos(true);
StelMovementMgr.zoomTo(40, 1);
core.wait(2);
for (i=0; i<250; i++)
{
core.setDate("+ 1 days");
core.wait(0.2);
}
core.setGuiVisible(true);
It’s better, but let’s draw the “path” of Mars! Add those line before the loop:
core.selectObjectByName("Mars", false);
SolarSystem.setFlagIsolatedTrails(true);
SolarSystem.setFlagTrails(true);
Hmm. . . let’s add a few strings with info for users (insert those lines after the header):
var color = "#ff9900";
var info = LabelMgr.labelScreen("A motion of Mars", 20, 20,
false, 24, color);
var apx = LabelMgr.labelScreen("Setup best viewing angle, FOV
and date/time.", 20, 50, false, 18, color);
LabelMgr.setLabelShow(info, true);
LabelMgr.setLabelShow(apx, true);
core.wait(2);
LabelMgr.setLabelShow(apx, false);
Let’s add some improvements to display info for users — change in the loop:
var label = LabelMgr.labelObject(" Normal motion, West to
East", "Mars", true, 16, color, "SE");
for (i=0; i<250; i++)
{
16.6 More Examples 195
core.setDate("+ 1 days");
if ((i % 10) == 0)
{
var strDate = "Day " + i;
LabelMgr.setLabelShow(apx, false);
var apx = LabelMgr.labelScreen(strDate, 20,
50, false, 16, color);
LabelMgr.setLabelShow(apx, true);
}
if (i == 75)
{
LabelMgr.deleteLabel(label);
label = LabelMgr.labelObject(" Retrograde or
opposite motion begins", "Mars",
true, 16, color, "SE");
core.wait(2);
LabelMgr.deleteLabel(label);
label = LabelMgr.labelObject(" Retrograde
motion", "Mars", true, 16, color,
"SE");
}
if (i == 160)
{
LabelMgr.deleteLabel(label);
label = LabelMgr.labelObject(" Normal motion
returns", "Mars", true, 16, color,
"SE");
core.wait(2);
LabelMgr.deleteLabel(label);
label = LabelMgr.labelObject(" Normal motion",
"Mars", true, 16, color, "SE");
}
core.wait(0.2);
}
20 Exercises . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247
17. Astronomical Concepts
This section includes some general notes on astronomy in an effort to outline some concepts that
are helpful to understand features of Stellarium. Material here is only an overview, and the reader is
encouraged to get hold of a couple of good books on the subject. A good place to start is a compact
guide and ephemeris such as the National Audubon Society Field Guide to the Night Sky1 . Also
recommended is a more complete textbook such as Universe. There are also some nice resources
on the net, like the Wikibooks Astronomy book2 .
5. Now increase the time rate. Press K , L , L , L , L – this should set the time rate so
the stars can be seen to rotate around a point in the sky about once every ten seconds. If
you watch Stellarium’s clock you’ll see this is the time it takes for one day to pass at this
accelerated rate.
The point which the stars appear to move around is one of the Celestial Poles.
The apparent movement of the stars is due to the rotation of the Earth. Our location as the
observer on the surface of the Earth affects how we perceive the motion of the stars. To an observer
standing at Earth’s North Pole, the stars all seem to rotate around the zenith (the point directly
upward). As the observer moves South towards the equator, the location of the celestial pole moves
down towards the horizon. At the Earth’s equator, the North celestial pole appears to be on the
Northern horizon.
Similarly, observers in the Southern hemisphere see the Southern celestial pole at the zenith
when they are at the South pole, and it moves to the horizon as the observer travels towards the
equator.
1. Leave time moving on nice and fast, and open the configuration window. Go to the location
tab and click on the map right at the top – i.e., set your location to the North pole. See how
the stars rotate parallel to the horizon, around a point right at the top of the screen. With the
field of view set to 90◦ and the horizon at the bottom of the screen, the top of the screen is
the zenith.
2. Now click on the map again, this time a little further South. You should see the positions of
the stars jump, and the centre of rotation has moved a little further down the screen.
3. Click on the map even further towards and equator. You should see the centre of rotation
having moved down again.
To help with the visualisation of the celestial sphere, turn on the equatorial grid by clicking the
button on the main tool-bar or pressing the E key. Now you can see grid lines drawn on the sky.
These lines are like lines of longitude and latitude on the Earth, but drawn for the celestial sphere.
The Celestial Equator is the line around the celestial sphere that is half way between the
celestial poles – just as the Earth’s equator is the line half way between the Earth’s poles.
3 In some textbooks azimuth is counted from south. There is no global authority to decide upon this issue,
just be aware of this when you compare numbers with other sources.
17.2 Coordinate Systems 201
Stellarium can draw grid lines for altitude/azimuth coordinates. Use the button on the
main tool-bar to activate this grid, or press the Z key.
In addition, the cardinal points can be highlighted using the button or Q key.
There are a few great circles with special names which Stellarium can draw (see section 4.4.4).
Meridian This is the vertical line which runs from the North point towards the zenith and further
to the South point.
(Mathematical) Horizon This is the line exactly 90◦ away from the zenith.
First Vertical This is the vertical line which runs from the East point towards the zenith and
further to the West point.
are measured from standard points on the celestial sphere. Right ascension α and declination δ are
to the celestial sphere what longitude and latitude are to terrestrial map makers.
The Northern celestial pole has a declination of δ = 90◦ , the celestial equator has a declination
of δ = 0◦ , and the Southern celestial pole has a declination of δ = −90◦ .
Right ascension is measured as an angle round from a point in the sky known as the First Point
of Aries, in the same way that longitude is measured around the Earth from Greenwich. Figure 17.2
illustrates RA/Dec coordinates. The angle α is usually expressed as time with minute and seconds,
with 15◦ equalling one hour.
Unlike Altitude/Azimuth coordinates, RA/Dec coordinates of a star do not change if the
observer changes latitude, and do not change noticeably over the course of the day due to the
rotation of the Earth. RA/Dec coordinates are generally used nowadays in star catalogues such as
the Hipparcos catalogue.
However, the story is complicated a little by precession (section 17.8) and parallax (sec-
tion 17.9). Precession causes a slow drift of the coordinates almost parallel to the ecliptic, and
17.2 Coordinate Systems 203
therefore star catalogues always have to specify their equinox of validity. Current catalogs and
atlases use coordinates for J2000.0.
Stellarium can draw grid lines for Equatorial coordinates. Use the button on the main
tool-bar to activate this grid, or press the E key to draw the equatorial grid for the simulation
time. The Markings dialog (4.4.4) allows you to set also the grid for J2000.0 standard coordinates.
In case you are observing from another celestial object, the equatorial coordinates use a system
similar to the one referring to the earth-based coordinates, but parallel to the planet’s rotational axis.
There are again a few great circles with special names which Stellarium can draw in addition,
both for simulation time and for J2000.0 (see section 4.4.4).
Celestial Equator the line directly above the earth’s (or more generally, the observer’s planet’s)
equator.
Colures These are lines similar to meridian and first vertical in the azimuthal system. The
Equinoctial Colure runs from the North Celestial Pole NCP through the First Point of Aries
à, South Celstial Pole SCP and First Point of Libra æ while the Solstitial Colure runs from
the NCP through First Point of Cancer ã, SCP and First Point of Capricorn é.
17.3 Distance
As D OUGLAS A DAMS (1952–2001) pointed out in The Hitchhiker’s Guide to the Galaxy (Adams,
1981),
Space [. . . ] is big. Really big. You just won’t believe how vastly, hugely, mind-
bogglingly big it is. I mean, you may think it’s a long way down the road to the
chemist, but that’s just peanuts to space.[p.76]
Astronomers use a variety of units for distance that make sense in the context of the mind-boggling
vastness of space.
Astronomical Unit (AU) This is the mean Earth-Sun distance. Roughly 150 million kilometres
(1.49598 × 108 km). The AU is used mainly when discussing the solar system – for example
the distance of various planets from the Sun.
Light year (LY) A light year is not, as some people believe, a measure of time. It is the distance
that light travels in a year. The speed of light being approximately 300,000 kilometres per
second means a light year is a very large distance indeed, working out at about 9.5 trillion
kilometres (9.46073 × 1012 km). Light years are most frequently used when describing the
distance of stars and galaxies or the sizes of large-scale objects like galaxies, nebulae etc.
Parsec (pc) A parsec is defined as the distance of an object that has an annual parallax of 1 second
of arc. This equates to 3.26156 light years (3.08568 × 1013 km). Parsecs (and derivatives:
kiloparsec kpc, megaparsec Mpc) are most frequently used when describing the distance of
stars or the sizes of large-scale objects like galaxies, nebulae etc.
17.4 Time
The length of a day is defined as the amount of time that it takes for the Sun to travel from the
highest point in the sky at mid-day to the next high-point on the next day. In astronomy this is
called a solar day. The apparent motion of the Sun is caused by the rotation of the Earth. However,
in this time, the Earth not only spins, it also moves slightly round its orbit. Thus in one solar day
the Earth does not spin exactly 360◦ on its axis. Another way to measure day length is to consider
how long it takes for the Earth to rotate exactly 360◦ . This is known as one sidereal day.
Figure 17.3 illustrates the motion of the Earth as seen looking down on the Earth orbiting the
Sun. The red triangle on the Earth represents the location of an observer. The figure shows the
Earth at four times:
1. The Sun is directly overhead - it is mid-day.
2. Twelve hours have passed since 1. The Earth has rotated round and the observer is on the
opposite side of the Earth from the Sun. It is mid-night. The Earth has also moved round in
its orbit a little.
3. The Earth has rotated exactly 360◦ . Exactly one sidereal day has passed since 1.
17.4 Time 205
4. It is mid-day again – exactly one solar day since 1. Note that the Earth has rotated more than
360◦ since 1.
It should be noted that in figure 17.3 the sizes of the Sun and Earth and not to scale. More
importantly, the distance the Earth moves around its orbit is much exaggerated. The Earth takes a
year to travel round the Sun – 365 14 solar days. The length of a sidereal day is about 23 hours, 56
minutes and 4 seconds.
only about 13 decimal places. More than 2.4 million days have passed, so that e.g. Jan-
uary 1, 2000, 12:00UT is 2451545.0, which is an accurately storable number with 7 decimal
places, but 12:34:56UT is computed as 2451545.02426. A more accurate result would yield
2451545.024259259259... So, for a field where sub-second accuracy became crucial like spacecraft
operations, the Modified Julian Day (MJD) has been introduced. It is simply
This means, days start at midnight, and the (constant, in our era) decimal places of the “big numbers”
at the begin of the number have been traded in for more decimal places at the end.
Don’t put your expectations too high when you see MJD displayed (section 4.1): Stellarium
uses a double-precision floating point number for JD for internal timekeeping, and Stellarium’s
display of MJD is simply computed from it. So you cannot set temporal increments smaller than a
second, and it hardly would make sense to expect more accuracy from the simulation algorithms.
17.4.3 Delta T
Until around 1900, the earth’s rotation was regarded as perfect standard of time. There were
86400 seconds per mean solar day, and the accuracy of reproducing time with mechanical clocks
only in this time started to become as good as the earth’s rotation itself.
Astronomers who computed solar eclipses reported in texts from antiquity wondered about a
required time shift which they originally attributed to a yet-unknown “secular acceleration of the
lunar motion”. However, it turned out that indeed the gravitational effect of the moon which causes
the tides also has effects on earth’s rotation: the tides slowly break earth’s rotational speed. The
energy is also transferred to the moon, and the acceleration leads to the moon slowly moving away
from the earth4 .
This led to the introduction of a time named Ephemeris Time (ET) with progresses in the speed
of the second in the year 1900, to be used for positional computation in our solar system, in addition
to Greenwich Mean Time (GMT), from which all zone times and “civil” clock times were derived.
The introduction of Atomic Clocks in the middle of the 20th century led to a redefinition of the
(temporal) second, which has been de-coupled from earth’s rotation. This time, the International
Atomic Time TAI, is the basis for Terrestrial Time TT which can be considered as constantly
progressing at constant speed5 , and is used for computation of the planetary positions.
Still, people living on earth prefer to have the mean solar noon governing the run of day and
night. Therefore all forms of civil time are linked to Coordinated Universal Time UTC. Seconds
in UTC and TAI are of equal length. The slow and irregular divergence between TAI and UTC is
observed by a few standardisation institutes. When necessary, a leap second can be introduced to
the UTC to bring the earth’s rotation back in sync so that the Mean Sun again culminates at noon.
The difference ∆T = T T −UT (or “Delta T”) describes the temporal offset which amounts
already to more than a minute in the 21st century. There have been many attempts to properly model
∆T , and Stellarium offers several models you can choose from in the configuration dialog (see
section 4.3.4). The default, “Espenak and Meeus (2006)”, is a widely accepted standard. But if you
are a researcher and want to experiment with alternative models, you will hopefully like this feature.
you can even specify your own data for a, b, c, y and the secular term for lunar acceleration n
4 No need to worry, the moon recedes from the earth only a few centimeters per year as measured with
the laser reflectors left by the Apollo astronauts in the 1970s. In a very far future, however, there will only be
annular solar eclipses as a consequence!
5 We don’t discuss relativity here. The advanced reader is referred to the presentation in the Wikipedia,
https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Delta_T.
17.4 Time 207
(actually ṅ = dn/dt in units of arcseconds/century2 ) if you can model ∆T according to the formula
∆T = a + b · u + c · u2 where (17.2)
year − y
u = (17.3)
100
List of ∆T models in Stellarium
The following list describes sources and a few details about the models for ∆T implemented in
Stellarium.
Without correction. Correction is disabled. Use only if you know what you are doing!
Schoch (1931). This historical formula was obtained by Schoch (1931) and was also used in “A
New Test of Einstein’s Theory of Relativity by Ancient Solar Eclipses” (Henriksson, 2009).
See for more in Peters (2010). ṅ = −29.6800 /cy2 .
Clemence (1948). This empirical equation was published in “On the system of astronomical
constants” (Clemence, 1948). Valid range of usage: between years 1681 and 1900. ṅ =
−22.4400 /cy2 .
IAU (1952). This formula is based on a study of post-1650 observations of the Sun, the Moon and
the planets (Spencer Jones, 1939) and reproduced in Astronomical Formulae for Calculators
(Meeus, 1988). It was also adopted in the PC program SunTracker Pro. Valid range of usage:
between years 1681 and 1936. ṅ = −22.4400 /cy2 .
Astronomical Ephemeris (1960). This is a slightly modified version of the IAU 1952 (Spencer
Jones, 1939) formula which was adopted in the “Astronomical Ephemeris” (Wilkins, 1961)
and in the Canon of Solar Eclipses -2003 to +2526 (Mucke and Meeus, 1983). Valid range
of usage: between years -500 and 2000. ṅ = −22.4400 /cy2 .
Tuckerman (1962, 1964) & Goldstine (1973). The famous tables (Tuckerman, 1962; Tuckerman,
1964) list the positions of the Sun, the Moon and the planets at 5- and 10-day intervals from
601 BCE to 1649 CE. The same relation was also implicitly adopted in the syzygy tables of
Goldstine (1973). Valid range of usage: between years -600 and 1649.
Muller & Stephenson (1975). This equation was published in “The accelerations of the earth and
moon from early astronomical observations” (Muller and F. R. Stephenson, 1975). Valid
range of usage: between years -1375 and 1975. ṅ = −37.500 /cy2 .
Stephenson (1978). This equation was published in “Pre-Telescopic Astronomical Observations”
(F. R. Stephenson, 1978). ṅ = −30.000 /cy2 .
Schmadel & Zech (1979). This 12th-order polynomial equation (outdated and superseded by
Schmadel and Zech (1988)) was published in “Polynomial approximations for the correction
delta T E.T.-U.T. in the period 1800-1975” (Schmadel and Zech, 1979) as fit through data
published by Brouwer (1952). Valid range of usage: between years 1800 and 1975, with
meaningless values outside this range. ṅ = −23.894600 /cy2 .
Morrison & Stephenson (1982). This algorithm Morrison and F. R. Stephenson, 1982 was
adopted in Planetary Programs and Tables from –4000 to +2800 (Pierre Bretagnon and
Simon, 1986) and in the PC planetarium program RedShift. Valid range of usage: between
years -4000 and 2800. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Stephenson & Morrison (1984). This formula was published in “Long-term changes in the rota-
tion of the earth - 700 B.C. to A.D. 1980” (F. R. Stephenson and Morrison, 1984). Valid
range of usage: between years -391 and 1600. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Stephenson & Houlden (1986). This algorithm (Houlden and F. Stephenson, 1986) is used in the
PC planetarium program Guide 7. Valid range of usage: between years -600 and 1600.
ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Espenak (1987, 1989). This algorithm was given in Fifty Year Canon of Solar Eclipses: 1986 –
2035 (Espenak, 1987) and in Fifty Year Canon of Lunar Eclipses: 1986 – 2035 (Espenak,
1989). Valid range of usage: between years 1950 and 2100.
208 Chapter 17. Astronomical Concepts
Borkowski (1988). This formula was obtained by Borkowski (1988) from an analysis of 31 solar
eclipse records dating between 2137 BCE and 1715 CE. Valid range of usage: between years
-2136 and 1715. ṅ = −23.89500 /cy2 .
Schmadel & Zech (1988). This 12th-order polynomial equation was published in “Empirical
Transformations from U.T. to E.T. for the Period 1800-1988” (Schmadel and Zech, 1988)
as data fit through values given by F. R. Stephenson and Morrison (1984). Valid range of
usage: between years 1800 and 1988, with a mean error of less than one second, max. error
1.9s, and meaningless values outside this range. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Chapront-Touze & Chapront (1991). This formula was adopted by M. Chapront-Touze & J.
Chapront in the shortened version of the ELP 2000-85 lunar theory in their Lunar Tables and
Programs from 4000 B.C. to A.D. 8000 (Chapront-Touzé and Chapront, 1991). The relations
are based on those of F. R. Stephenson and Morrison (1984), but slightly modified to make
them compatible with the tidal acceleration parameter of ṅ = −23.894600 /cy2 adopted in the
ELP 2000-85 lunar theory (Chapront-Touzé and Chapront, 1988a).
Stephenson & Morrison (1995). This equation was published in “Long-Term Fluctuations in the
Earth’s Rotation: 700 BC to AD 1990” (F. R. Stephenson and Morrison, 1995). Valid range
of usage: between years -700 and 1600. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Stephenson (1997). F. R. Stephenson published this formula in his book Historical Eclipses and
Earth’s Rotation (F. Richard Stephenson, 1997). Valid range of usage: between years -500
and 1600. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Meeus (1998) (with Chapront, Chapront-Touze & Francou (1997)). From Astronomical Algo-
rithms (Meeus, 1998), and widely used. Table for 1620..2000, and includes a variant of
Chapront, Chapront-Touze & Francou (1997) for dates outside 1620..2000. Valid range of
usage: between years -400 and 2150. ṅ = −25.737600 /cy2 .
JPL Horizons. The JPL Solar System Dynamics Group of the NASA Jet Propulsion Laboratory
use this formula in their interactive website JPL Horizons6 . Valid range of usage: between
years -2999 and 1620, with zero values outside this range. ṅ = −25.737600 /cy2 .
Meeus & Simons (2000). This polynome was published in “Polynomial approximations to Delta
T, 1620-2000 AD” (Meeus and Simons, 2000). Valid range of usage: between years 1620
and 2000, with zero values outside this range. ṅ = −25.737600 /cy2 .
Montenbruck & Pfleger (2000). The fourth edition of Astronomy on the Personal Computer
(Montenbruck and Pfleger, 2000) provides simple 3rd-order polynomial data fits for the
recent past. Valid range of usage: between years 1825 and 2005, with a typical 1-second
accuracy and zero values outside this range.
Reingold & Dershowitz (2002, 2007, 2018). E. M. Reingold & N. Dershowitz present this poly-
nomial data fit in Calendrical Calculations: The Ultimate Edition (Reingold and Dershowitz,
2018) and in their Calendrical Calculations (Reingold and Dershowitz, 2007), Calendri-
cal Tabulations 1900-2200 (Reingold and Dershowitz, 2002). It is based on Astronomical
Algorithms (Meeus, 1991).
Morrison & Stephenson (2004, 2005). This important solution was published in “Historical val-
ues of the Earth’s clock error ∆T and the calculation of eclipses” (Morrison and F. R.
Stephenson, 2004) with addendum (Morrison and F. R. Stephenson, 2005). Valid range of
usage: between years -1000 and 2000. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Stephenson, Morrison & Hohenkerk (2016). This important new solution was published in
“Measurement of the Earth’s rotation: 720 BC to AD 2015” (F. R. Stephenson, Morri-
son, and Hohenkerk, 2016). The solution combines a spline fit to observations (used between
the given limits) with a parabolic fit (used as fallback outside the range, but without smooth
transitions at the limits, i.e., values for 2016 and later deviate notably from current estimates,
6 http://ssd.jpl.nasa.gov/?horizons
17.5 Angles 209
and should not be used for dates after 2015). Recommended range of usage: between years
-720.0 and 2016.0 ṅ = −25.8200 /cy2 .
Espenak & Meeus (2006). This solution7 by F. Espenak and J. Meeus, based on Morrison and
F. R. Stephenson (2004) and a polynomial fit through tabulated values for 1600-2000, is
used for the NASA Eclipse Web Site8 and in their Five Millennium Canon of Solar Eclipses:
-1900 to +3000 (Espenak and Meeus, 2006). This formula is also used in the solar, lunar and
planetary ephemeris program SOLEX. Valid range of usage: between years -1999 and 3000.
ṅ = −25.85800 /cy2 .
Reijs (2006). From the Length of Day (LOD; as determined by Morrison and F. R. Stephenson
(2004)), Victor Reijs derived a ∆T formula by using a Simplex optimisation with a cosine
and square function9 . This is based on a possible periodicy described by Morrison and F. R.
Stephenson (2004). Valid range of usage: between years -1500 and 1100. ṅ = −26.000 /cy2 .
Banjevic (2006). This solution is based on F. R. Stephenson and Morrison (1984) and was
published in “Ancient eclipses and dating the fall of Babylon” (Banjevic, 2006). Valid
range of usage: between years -2020 and 1620, with zero values outside this range. ṅ =
−26.000 /cy2 .
Islam, Sadiq & Qureshi (2008, 2013). This solution by S. Islam, M. Sadiq and M. S. Qureshi,
based on Meeus and Simons (2000), was published in “Error Minimization of Polynomial
Approximation of Delta T” (Islam, Sadiq, and Qureshi, 2008) and revisited by Sana Islam
in 2013. Valid range of usage: between years 1620 and 2007, with zero values outside this
range.
Khalid, Sultana & Zaidi (2014). This polynomial approximation with 0.6 seconds of accuracy
was published in “Delta T: Polynomial Approximation of Time Period 1620–2013” (Khalid,
Sultana, and Zaidi, 2014). Valid range of usage: between years 1620 and 2013, with zero
values outside this range. v0.18.2
Henriksson (2017). A solution which combines Schoch’s 1931 solution (parabolic fit) with a
discussion of and correction for relativistic effects. The author claims an accurate fit for
Solar eclipses probably depicted in artefacts going back to the mid-fourth millennium
BC. Also with this setting, the exact times from his paper (Henriksson, 2017) cannot be
reproduced probably because the author used a different ephemeris, but the phenomena are
plausibly reproduced. Recommended range of usage: between years -4000.0 and 2000.0
ṅ = −30.12800 /cy2 .
Custom equation of ∆T . This is the quadratic formula 17.2 for calculation of ∆T with coefficients
defined by the user.
17.5 Angles
Astronomers typically use degrees to measure angles. Since many observations require very precise
measurement, the degree is subdivided into sixty minutes of arc also known as arc-minutes. Each
minute of arc is further subdivided into sixty seconds of arc, or arc-seconds. Thus one degree is
equal to 3600 seconds of arc. Finer grades of precision are usually expressed using the SI prefixes
with arc-seconds, e.g. milli arc-seconds (one milli arc-second is one thousandth of an arc-second).
17.5.1 Notation
Degrees are denoted using the ◦ symbol after a number. Minutes of arc are denoted with a 0 , and
seconds of arc are denoted using 00 . Angles are frequently given in two formats:
7 This solution is used by default.
8 http://eclipse.gsfc.nasa.gov/eclipse.html
9 http://www.iol.ie/~geniet/eng/DeltaTeval.htm
210 Chapter 17. Astronomical Concepts
1. DMS format — degrees, minutes and seconds. For example 90◦ 150 1200 . When more precision
is required, the seconds component may include a decimal part, for example 90◦ 150 12.43200 .
2. Decimal degrees, for example 90.2533◦
Object m M
The Sun -27 4.8
Vega 0.05 0.6
Betelgeuse 0.47 -7.2
Sirius (the brightest star) -1.5 1.4
Venus (at brightest) -4.4 —
Full Moon (at brightest) -12.6 —
17.7 Luminosity
Luminosity is an expression of the total energy radiated by a star. It may be measured in watts,
however, astronomers tend to use another expression — solar luminosities where an object with
twice the Sun’s luminosity is considered to have two solar luminosities and so on. Luminosity is
related to absolute magnitude.
17.8 Precession
As the Earth orbits the Sun throughout the year, the axis of rotation (the line running through
the rotational poles of the Earth) seems to point towards the same position on the celestial sphere,
as can be seen in figure 17.4. The angle between the axis of rotation and the perpendicular of the
orbital plane is called the obliquity of the ecliptic. It is currently about 23◦ 270 and is the angle
between equatorial coordinates (17.2.2) and ecliptical coordinates (17.2.3).
Observed over very long periods of time the direction the axis of rotation points to does actually
change. The angle between the axis of rotation and the orbital plane stays fairly constant, but the
direction the axis points — the position of the celestial pole — transcribes a figure similar to a
circle on the stars in the celestial sphere. The motion is similar to the way in which a gyroscope
slowly twists, as figure 17.5 illustrates. This process is called precession. The circles can be shown
in Stellarium: From the View menu ( F4 ), tab “Markings”, switch on “Precession Circles” (4.4.4).
Precession is a slow process. The axis of rotation twists through a full 360◦ about once
every 26,000 years. However, over these long times other gravitational perturbations (“planetary
precession”) play a role, and what may be thought of as rigid “precession circle” can actually only
show the instantaneous (current) state. Over millennia the circle slightly varies.
212 Chapter 17. Astronomical Concepts
Zet Pup
-100
Sirius
Gam Cen
-200
Sig Sgr
Eps Sgr
Lam Sco
-300
Antares
-400
The Cen
Spica
-500
The Sco
Alphard
-600
Deneb Kaitos
-700 Del CMa Eps CMa
Alnitak Bet CMa
Betelgeuse Alnilam Kap Ori
Gam Ori Mintaka Lam Vel
-800
-900
Rigel
-1000
Azimuth 90 95 100 105 110 115 120 125 130 135
Geograpical Latitude: 30°0’ 0’’. Stars to mag=2.25. Azimuths from North, without refraction. © Georg Zotti 2010, http://astrosim.univie.ac.at
Figure 17.6: Precession: Change of rising positions of the stars along the eastern horizon
from azimuths 85 to 135 degrees, between years 1000 BC and 0, for latitude ϕ = 30◦ .
17.9 Parallax 213
17.9 Parallax
Parallax is the change of angular position of two stationary points relative to each other as seen by
an observer, due to the motion of said observer. Or more simply put, it is the apparent shift of an
object against a background due to a change in observer position.
This can be demonstrated by holding ones thumb up at arm’s length. Closing one eye, note the
position of the thumb against the background. After swapping which eye is open (without moving),
the thumb appears to be in a different position against the background.
As can be seen from figure 17.7, the annual parallax p is half the angular distance between the
apparent positions of the nearby star. The distance of the nearby object is d. Astronomers use a unit
of distance called the parsec ( pc) which is defined as the distance at which a nearby star has p = 100 .
Even the nearest stars exhibit very small movement due to parallax. The closest star to the
Earth other than the Sun is Proxima Centauri. It has an annual parallax of 0.7719900 , corresponding
to a distance of 1.295 pc (4.22 light years).
Even with the most sensitive instruments for measuring the positions of the stars it is only
possible to use parallax to determine the distance of stars up to about 1,600 light years from the
Earth, after which the annual parallax is so small it cannot be measured accurately enough.
In Stellarium, the annual parallax can be listed in the object information for stars when available.
It is not used for the positional calculations.
This chapter focuses on the observational side of astronomy — what we see when we look at the
sky.
18.2 Stars
The Sun is just one of billions of stars. Even though many stars have a much greater absolute
magnitude than the Sun (they give out more light), they have an enormously smaller apparent
magnitude due to their large distance. Stars have a variety of forms — different sizes, brightnesses,
218 Chapter 18. Astronomical Phenomena
temperatures, and colours. Measuring the position, distance and attributes of the stars is known as
astrometry, and is a major part of observational astronomy.
18.2.2 Constellations
The constellations are groupings of stars that are visually close to one another in the sky. The
actual groupings are fairly arbitrary — different cultures have grouped stars together into different
constellations. In many cultures, the various constellations have been associated with mythological
entities. As such people have often projected pictures into the skies as can be seen in figure 18.1
which shows the constellation of Ursa Major. On the left is a picture with the image of the mythical
Great Bear, on the right only a line-art version (or stick figure) is shown. The seven bright stars of
Ursa Major are widely recognised, known variously as “the plough”, the “pan-handle”, and the
“big dipper”. This sub-grouping is known as an asterism — a distinct grouping of stars. On the
right, the picture of the bear has been removed and only a constellation diagram remains.
Stellarium can draw both constellation diagrams and artistic representations of the constellations.
Multiple sky cultures are supported: Western, Polynesian, Egyptian, Chinese, and several other sky
cultures are available, although at time of writing the non-Western constellations are not complete,
and as yet there are no artistic representations of these sky-cultures.
Aside from historical and mythological value, to the modern astronomer the constellations
provide a way to segment the sky for the purposes of describing locations of objects, indeed one of
18.2 Stars 219
the first tasks for an amateur observer is learning the constellations — the process of becoming
familiar with the relative positions of the constellations, at what time of year a constellation is
visible, and in which constellations observationally interesting objects reside. The International
Astronomical Union has adopted 88 “Western” constellations as a common system for segmenting
the sky (Table 18.1). They are based on Greek/Roman mythology, but with several additions from
Renaissance and later centuries. As such some formalisation has been adopted, each constellation
having a proper name, which is in Latin, and a three letter abbreviation of that name. For example,
Ursa Major has the abbreviation UMa. Also, the “Western” constellation have clearly defined
boundaries (Delporte, 1930), which you can draw in Stellarium when you press the B key1 . The
IAU constellation a selected object is placed in is also available in the object information data
(Roman, 1987), regardless of the currently active skyculture. On the other hand, the shapes of
mythological figures, and also stick figures, have not been canonized, so you will find deviations
between Stellarium and printed atlases.
Bayer Designation
The German astronomer J OHANN BAYER (1572–1625) devised one such system for his atlas, the
Uranographia, first published in 1603. His scheme names the stars according to the constellation
in which they lie prefixed by a lower case Greek letter (see Tab. 18.2), starting at α for (usually)
the brightest star in the constellation and proceeding with β , γ, . . . in descending order of apparent
magnitude. For example, such a Bayer Designation for Sirius is “α Canis Majoris” (note that
the genitive form of the constellation name is used, refer to Table 18.1; today also the short form
α CMa is in use). There are some exceptions to the descending magnitude ordering, and some
multiple stars (both real and optical) are named with a numerical superscript after the Greek letter,
e.g. π 1 ... π 6 Orionis.
Flamsteed Designation
English astronomer J OHN F LAMSTEED (1646–1719) numbered stars in each constellation in order
of increasing right ascension followed by the genitive form of the constellation name, for example
“61 Cygni” (or short: “61 Cyg”).
1 These boundaries or borders have been drawn using star maps from 1875. Due to the effect of precession,
these borders are no longer parallel to today’s coordinates.
220 Chapter 18. Astronomical Phenomena
Hipparcos
Hipparcos (for High Precision Parallax Collecting Satellite) was an astrometry mission of the
European Space Agency (ESA) dedicated to the measurement of stellar parallax and the proper
motions of stars. The project was named in honour of the Greek astronomer H IPPARCHUS.
Ideas for such a mission dated from 1967, with the mission accepted by ESA in 1980. The
satellite was launched by an Ariane 4 on 8 August 1989. The original goal was to place the satellite
in a geostationary orbit above the earth, however a booster rocket failure resulted in a highly
elliptical orbit from 315 to 22,300 miles altitude. Despite this difficulty, all of the scientific goals
were accomplished. Communications were terminated on 15 August 1993.
The program was divided in two parts: the Hipparcos experiment whose goal was to measure
the five astrometric parameters of some 120,000 stars to a precision of some 2 to 4 milli arc-seconds
and the Tycho experiment, whose goal was the measurement of the astrometric and two-colour
photometric properties of some 400,000 additional stars to a somewhat lower precision.
The final Hipparcos Catalogue (120,000 stars with 1 milli arc-second level astrometry) and the
final Tycho Catalogue (more than one million stars with 20-30 milli arc-second astrometry and
two-colour photometry) were completed in August 1996. The catalogues were published by ESA in
June 1997. The Hipparcos and Tycho data have been used to create the Millennium Star Atlas: an
all-sky atlas of one million stars to visual magnitude 11, from the Hipparcos and Tycho Catalogues
and 10,000 non-stellar objects included to complement the catalogue data.
There were questions over whether Hipparcos has a systematic error of about 1 milli arc-second
222 Chapter 18. Astronomical Phenomena
in at least some parts of the sky. The value determined by Hipparcos for the distance to the Pleiades
is about 10% less than the value obtained by some other methods. By early 2004, the controversy
remained unresolved.
Stellarium uses the Hipparcos Catalogue for star data, as well as having traditional names
for many of the brighter stars. The stars tab of the search window allows for searching based
on a Hipparcos Catalogue number (as well as traditional names), e.g. the star Sadalmelik in the
constellation of Aquarius can be found by searching for the name, or its Hipparcos number, 109074.
Figure 18.2 shows the information Stellarium displays when a star is selected. At the top, the
common name, Bayer/Flamsteed designations and Hipparcos number are shown, followed by the
RA/Dec coordinates, apparent magnitude, distance and other data.
These are known as dwarf stars, among them white dwarfs (dying stars) and brown dwarfs (“failed
stars”).
The luminosity class is an indication of the type of star — whether it is main sequence, a
giant or a dwarf. Luminosity classes are denoted by a number in roman numerals, as described in
table 18.4.
Plotting the luminosity of stars against their spectral type/surface temperature gives a diagram
called a Hertzsprung-Russell diagram (after the two astronomers E JNAR H ERTZSPRUNG (1873–
1967) and H ENRY N ORRIS RUSSELL (1877–1957) who devised it). A slight variation of this is
shown in figure 18.3 (which is technically a colour/magnitude in figure 18.3 (which is technically a
colour/magnitude plot).
New Moon The moon’s disc is fully in shadow, or there is just a slither of illuminated
surface on the edge.
Waxing Crescent Less than half the disc is illuminated, but more is illuminated each night.
First Quarter Approximately half the disc is illuminated, and increasing each night.
Waxing Gibbous More than half of the disc is illuminated, and still increasing each night.
Full Moon The whole disc of the moon is illuminated.
Waning Gibbous More than half of the disc is illuminated, but the amount gets smaller each
night.
Last Quarter Approximately half the disc is illuminated, but this gets less each night.
Waning Crescent Less than half the disc of the moon is illuminated, and this gets less each
night.
18.5.1 Asteroids
Asteroids are celestial bodies orbiting the Sun in more or less regular orbits mostly between Mars
and Jupiter. They are generally rocky bodies like the inner (terrestrial) planets, but of much smaller
size. They are countless in number ranging in size from about ten meters to hundreds of kilometres.
18.5.2 Comets
A comet is a small body in the solar system that orbits the Sun and (at least occasionally) exhibits a
coma (or atmosphere) and/or a tail.
Most comets have a very eccentric orbit (featuring a highly flattened ellipse, or even a parabolic
track), and as such spend most of their time a very long way from the Sun. Comets are composed
of rock, dust and ices. When they come close to the Sun, the heat evaporates the ices, causing a
gaseous release. This gas and loose material which comes away from the body of the comet is
swept away from the Sun by the Solar wind, forming the tail.
18.6 Meteoroids 227
Most larger comets exhibit two kinds of tail: a straight gas tail (often blue-green in photographs),
and a wider, occasionally curved dust tail (reflecting whitish sunlight).
Comets whose orbit brings them close to the Sun more frequently than every 200 years are
considered to be short period comets, the most famous of which is probably Comet Halley, named
after the British astronomer E DMUND H ALLEY (1656–1741/423 ), which has an orbital period of
roughly 76 years.
18.6 Meteoroids
These objects are small pieces of space debris left over from the early days of the solar system or
which crumbled off a comet when it came close to the sun. These particles orbit the Sun and come
in a variety of shapes, sizes an compositions, ranging from microscopic dust particles up to about
ten meters across.
Sometimes these objects collide with the Earth. The closing speed of these collisions is
generally extremely high (tens of kilometres per second). When such an object ploughs through the
Earth’s atmosphere, a large amount of kinetic energy is converted into heat and light, and a visible
flash or streak can often be seen with the naked eye. Even the smallest particles can cause these
events which are commonly known as shooting stars.
While smaller objects tend to burn up in the atmosphere, larger, denser objects can penetrate
the atmosphere and strike the surface of the planet, sometimes leaving meteor craters.
Sometimes the angle of the collision means that larger objects pass through the atmosphere but
do not strike the Earth. When this happens, spectacular fireballs are sometimes seen.
To clarify some terminology:
Meteoroids are the objects when they are floating in space.
Meteor is the name given to the visible atmospheric phenomenon.
Shooting Star colloquial term for a small meteor
Fireball, Bolide term for a very bright meteor. These illuminate the landscape, sometimes
for several seconds, and occasionally even cause sounds. These are also candidates for
Meteorites , the objects that penetrate the atmosphere and land (or impact) on the surface.
In some nights over the year you can observe increased meteorite activity. Those meteors seem
to come from a certain point in the sky, the Radiant. But what we see is similar to driving through a
mosquito swarm which all seem to come head-on. Earth itself moves through space, and sweeps up
a dense cloud of particles which originates from a comet’s tail. Stellarium’s Meteor Shower plugin
(see section 13.6) can help you planning your next meteor observing night.
18.9 Nebulae
Seen with the naked eye, binoculars or a small telescope, a nebula (plural nebulae) is a fuzzy patch
on the sky. Historically, the term referred to any extended object, but the modern definition excludes
some types of object such as galaxies.
Observationally, nebulae are popular objects for amateur astronomers – they exhibit complex
structure, spectacular colours (in most cases only visible in color photography) and a wide variety
of forms. Many nebulae are bright enough to be seen using good binoculars or small to medium
sized telescopes, and are a very photogenic subject for astro-photographers.
Nebulae are associated with a variety of phenomena, some being clouds of interstellar dust and
gas in the process of collapsing under gravity, some being envelopes of gas thrown off during a
supernova event (so called supernova remnants), yet others being the remnants of dumped outer
layers around dying stars (planetary nebulae).
Examples of nebulae for which Stellarium has images include the Crab Nebula (M1), which
is a supernova remnant, and the Dumbbell Nebula (M27) and the Ring Nebula (M57) which are
planetary nebulae.
18.10 Galaxies
Stars, it seems, are gregarious – they like to live together in groups. These groups are called galaxies.
The number of stars in a typical galaxy is literally astronomical – many billions – sometimes over
hundreds of billions of stars!
Our own star, the sun, is part of a galaxy. When we look up at the night sky, all the stars we
can see are in the same galaxy. We call our own galaxy the Milky Way (or sometimes simply “the
Galaxy”4 ).
Other galaxies appear in the sky as dim fuzzy blobs. Only four are normally visible to the
naked eye. The Andromeda galaxy (M31) visible in the Northern hemisphere, the two Magellanic
clouds, visible in the Southern hemisphere, and the home galaxy Milky Way, visible in parts from
north and south under dark skies.
There are thought to be billions of galaxies in the universe comprised of an unimaginably large
number of stars.
The vast majority of galaxies are so far away that they are very dim, and cannot be seen without
large telescopes, but there are dozens of galaxies which may be observed in medium to large sized
amateur instruments. Stellarium includes images of many galaxies, including the Andromeda
galaxy (M31), the Pinwheel Galaxy (M101), the Sombrero Galaxy (M104) and many others.
Astronomers classify galaxies according to their appearance. Some classifications include
spiral galaxies, elliptical galaxies, lenticular galaxies and irregular galaxies.
4 Which means closely the same thing, the word deriving from Greek gala=milk.
230 Chapter 18. Astronomical Phenomena
18.11 Eclipses
Eclipses occur when an apparently large celestial body (planet, moon etc.) moves between the
observer (that’s you!) and a more distant object – the more distant object being eclipsed by the
nearer one.
0°
−2 −1 0 1 2 3 4 5 mag = 6
(Model: Schaefer, S&T4/1987; Airmass: Rozenberg 1966; Observations: Müller 1970) © Georg Zotti 2009−2010, ASTROSIM
Figure 18.5: Airmass and Extinction. The figure shows Airmass (blue) along the line of
sight in the altitude labeled on the left side. The green curves show how many magnitudes
an object is dimmed down, depending on extinction factor k (called kv in the figure). The
red curves indicate at which altitude a star of given magnitude can be seen with good
eyesight, again depending on k. The black dots are observed values found in the literature.
impossible. When planning what you want to observe, take the phase and position of the
Moon into account. Of course Stellarium is the ideal tool for finding this out!
Averted vision A curious fact about the eye is that it is more sensitive to dim light towards the
edge of the field of view. If an object is slightly too dim to see directly, looking slightly off
to the side but concentrating on the object’s location can often reveal it.
Angular distance Learn how to estimate angular distances. Learn the angular distances described
in section 17.5.2. If you have a pair of binoculars, find out the angular distance across the
field of view and use this as a standard measure.
(Fig. 18.5). The number of air masses increases fast in low altitudes, this is why we see so few
stars along the horizon. Usually blue light is extinguished more, this is why the sun and moon (and
brigher stars) appear reddish on the horizon.
Stellarium can simulate extinction, and you can set the opacity of your atmosphere with a
global factor k, the magnitude loss per airmass (see section 4.4.2). The best mountaintop sites may
have k = 0.15, while k = 0.25 seems a value usable for good locations in lower altitudes.
Scintillation
Scintillation is the scientific name of the twinkling which stars show in turbulent atmosphere. The
twinkling is caused by moving pockets of air with different temperature. Observe a star low on the
horizon with a telescope, and you will note it does not stand still but dances around a bit, often also
changing color to show red or blue hues. While the twinkling of stars may look fine and comforting
to the naked eye on a nice warm summer evening, telescopic observers and astrophotographers
don’t like it at all. They rather complain about “bad seeing”, because it deteriorates the optical
resolution of their instruments and photographs.
Just like extinction and refraction are stronger along the horizon, stars in low altitude in general
show more twinkling than stars higher up in the sky.
Note that planets seem to be affected less by scintillation: they are not point sources, but little
disks, and so the effect of the turbulent pockets of air distorting different parts of the disks cancels
out a bit when observing with the naked eye: planets appear to be more stable. Of course, the view
in a telescope will still be deteriorated by the turbulent atmosphere.
While bad seeing was one key motivation of sending telescopes into earth orbit since the 1970s,
the latest generation of ground-based giant telescopes is able to compensate for the turbulent motion
by rapidly deforming their secondary mirror.
20°
15°
10°
5°
0°
−5°
−10°
−1.3° −1.2° −1.1° −1.0° −0.9° −0.8° −0.7° −0.6° −0.5° −0.4° −0.3° −0.2° −0.1° 0.0° 0.1° 0.2° 0.3° 0.4° 0.5° 0.6° 0.7° 0.8° 0.9° Dalt
(Model: Meeus, Astr.Alg.1994) © Georg Zotti 2010, ASTROSIM
Figure 18.6: Refraction. The figure shows corrective values (degrees) which are subtracted from observed altitudes (left side) to reach geometric
altitudes, or values to be added to computed values (right side). The models used are not directly inverse operations.
233
234 Chapter 18. Astronomical Phenomena
Bortle Dark Sky Scale (see Appendix B). Given that public lighting became bright enough to cause
adverse effects on observability only during the 19th century, Stellarium presents an unpolluted
sky for dates before 1825. Note that of course light pollution was not switched on over night, but
became gradually noticeable over decades, but you have to estimate the appropriate level.
In addition, local variations of the amount of light pollution can be included in a light pollution
layer in the landscapes, see section 7 for details. This foreground layer may include all kinds of
light, e.g. campfires, so this is also available for earlier dates.
19. A Little Sky Guide
This chapter lists some astronomical objects that can be located using Stellarium. All of them
can be seen with the naked eye or binoculars. Since many astronomical objects have more than
one name (often having a “proper name”, a “common name” and various catalogue numbers), the
chapter lists the name as it appears in Stellarium — use this name when using Stellarium’s search
function — and any other commonly used names.
The Location Guide entry gives brief instructions for finding each object using nearby bright
stars or groups of stars when looking at the real sky — a little time spent learning the major
constellations visible from your latitude will pay dividends when it comes to locating fainter (and
more interesting!) objects. When trying to locate these objects in the night sky, keep in mind that
Stellarium displays many stars that are too faint to be visible without optical aid, and even bright
stars can be dimmed by poor atmospheric conditions and light pollution.
Location Guide: Find the three bright stars that constitute the main part of the constellation of
Andromeda. From the middle of these look toward the constellation of Cassiopeia.
M31 is the most distant object visible to the naked eye, and among the few nebulae that can be
seen without a telescope or powerful binoculars. Under good conditions it appears as a large fuzzy
patch of light. It is a galaxy containing billions of stars whose distance is roughly 2.5 million light
years from Earth.
has two other bright stars nearby forming a distinctive triangle — δ is at the head of this triangle
in the direction of Cassiopeia.
δ Cephei gives its name to a whole class of variables, all of which are pulsating high-mass stars
in the later stages of their evolution. δ Cephei is also a double star with a companion of magnitude
6.3 visible in binoculars.
Figure 19.1: Albireo: A Bright and Beautiful Double. Credit & Copyright: Richard
Yandrick.
19.26 The Double Cluster, χ and h Persei, NGC 884 and NGC 869
Type: Open Clusters
Location Guide: The two open clusters near stars χ and h in the constellation Perseus.
The Double Cluster (also known as Caldwell 14 or C14) is the common name for the naked-eye
open clusters NGC 869 and NGC 884 (often designated h Persei and χ Persei, respectively). The
Double Cluster is approximately the radiant of the Perseid meteor shower, which peaks annually
around August 12 or 13. Although easy to locate in the northern sky, observing the Double
Cluster in its two parts requires optical aid. They are described as being an “awe-inspiring” and
“breathtaking” sight, and are often cited as targets in astronomical observers’ guides.
242 Chapter 19. A Little Sky Guide
Figure 19.2: Small and Large Magellanic Clouds over Paranal Observatory. Credit: ESO/J.
Colosimo.
a globular cluster in the future (Bosch, E. Terlevich, and R. Terlevich, 2009). The closest supernova
observed since the invention of the telescope, Supernova 1987A, occurred in the outskirts of the
Tarantula Nebula.
Figure 19.3: The Coalsack Nebula taken by the Wide Field Imager on the MPG/ESO
2.2-metre telescope. Credit: ESO.
Way. The size of the nebula is roughly 0.5◦ , and its distance from earth is estimated at about 2000
light years.
20. Exercises
20.1.1 Simulation
1. Set the location to a mid-Northern latitude if necessary (M31 isn’t always visible for Southern
hemisphere observers). The UK is ideal.
2. Find M31 and set the time so that the sky is dark enough to see it. The best time of year for
this at Northern latitudes is Autumn/Winter, although there should be a chance to see it at
some time of night throughout the year.
3. Set the field of view to 6◦ (or the field of view of your binoculars if they’re different. 6◦ is
typical for 7x50 binoculars).
4. Practise finding M31 from the bright stars in Cassiopeia and the constellation of Andromeda.
Learn the chain of stars that extends from Andromeda’s central star perpendicular to her
body.
The method here below is just one way to do it – feel free to use another method of your own
construction!
Hold your hand at arm’s length with your hand open – the tips of your thumb and little finger
as far apart as you can comfortably hold them. Get a friend to measure the distance between your
thumb and your eye, we’ll call this D. There is a tendency to over-stretch the arm when someone
is measuring it – try to keep the thumb-eye distance as it would be if you were looking at some
distant object.
Without changing the shape of your hand, measure the distance between the tips of your thumb
and little finger. It’s probably easiest to mark their positions on a piece of paper and measure the
distance between the marks, we’ll call this d. Using some simple trigonometry, we can estimate the
angular distance θ using equation (17.4).
Repeat the process for the distance across a closed fist, three fingers and the tip of the little
finger.
For example, for one author D = 72 cm, d = 21 cm, so:
1◦
21
θ = 2 · arctan ≈ 16 (20.1)
144 2
Remember that handy angles are not very precise – depending on your posture at a given time
the values may vary by a fair bit.
20.6 Analemma
Set a time around noon and set time rate to pause, turn on the azimuthal grid. Find the Sun and
check its horizontal coordinates. Use the date and time panel and see how the horizontal coordinates
of the Sun change over time (please use one time step for simulation — look at the position of the
Sun every 7 days for example). Use the location panel and see how the positions of the Sun look
from different location at the same times. Check the change of positions of the Sun on Mars at the
same times.
20.7 Transit of Venus 249
F Accuracy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 319
H Acknowledgements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 331
Bibliography . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 341
Index . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 349
A. Default Hotkeys
The currently configured hotkeys are visible in the Help dialog ( F1 ). Here is the default list for
reference.
O Planet orbits
Shift + T Planet trails
Ctrl + Shift + P Planet selection marker
Alt + N Nomenclature labels
S Stars
Alt + S Stars labels
D Deep-sky objects (symbols)
I Deep-sky objects background images
Ctrl + I Reload the deep-sky objects background images
Ctrl + Alt + D Toggle Hierarchical Progressive Surveys (experimental)
M Milky Way
Ctrl + Shift + Z Zodiacal Light
G Ground
F Fog
Shift + G Landscape Illumination
Ctrl + Shift + G Landscape Labels
A Atmosphere
Q Cardinal points
, Ecliptic line
. Equator line
E Equatorial grid
Z Azimuthal grid
H Horizon line
; Meridian line
C Constellation lines
V Constellation labels
R Constellation art
B Constellation boundaries
Ctrl + Alt + Shift + V Select single constellation
Tab Remove selection of constellations
Ctrl + Shift + N Native planet names (from starlore)
Alt + V Asterism labels
Alt + A Asterism lines
Alt + R Ray helpers
Ctrl + Alt + I Reload the sky culture
W Remove selection of constellations
Alt + W Select all constellations
F11 Full-screen mode
Ctrl + N Night mode
Ctrl + Shift + H Flip scene horizontally
Ctrl + Shift + V Flip scene vertically
A.3 Miscellaneous 255
A.3 Miscellaneous
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + C Copy selected object information to clipboard
Ctrl + Q Quit
Ctrl + S Save screenshot
Ctrl + M Switch between equatorial and azimuthal mount
Ctrl + T Toggle visibility of GUI
Ctrl + R , P Reload shaders (for development)
256 Appendix A. Default Hotkeys
A.6 Scripts
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + D , 0 Run script “Solar System Screensaver”
Ctrl + D , 1 Run script “Western Constellations Tour”
Ctrl + D , 2 Run script “Sky Culture Tour”
Ctrl + D , 3 Run script “Screensaver”
Ctrl + D , B Run script “Skybox Tiles”
Ctrl + D , M , 1 Run script “Jupiter and triple shadow phenomena”
Ctrl + D , M , 2 Run script “Jupiter without Galilean satellites”
Ctrl + D , M , 3 Run script “Occultations of bright stars by planets”
Ctrl + D , M , 4 Run script “Mutual occultations of planets”
A.7 Windows
Shortcut key Description
F1 Toggle Help window
F2 Toggle Configuration window
F3 Toggle Search window
F4 Toggle Sky and viewing options window
F5 Toggle Date/time window
F6 Toggle Location window
F7 Toggle Shortcuts window
F10 Toggle Astronomical calculations window
F12 Toggle Script Console window
Alt + B Toggle Bookmarks window
A.8 Plugins
A.8.1 Angle Measure
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + A Toggle angle measurement
A.8.2 ArchaeoLines
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + U Toggle archaeolines
Ctrl + Shift + U Toggle archaeolines dialog
A.8.4 Exoplanets
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + Alt + E Show exoplanets
Alt + E Toggle Exoplanets configuration window
A.8.7 Oculars
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + O Ocular view
Alt + O Oculars popup menu
Alt + C Show crosshairs
Ctrl + B Telrad sight
A.8.8 Pulsars
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + Alt + P Show pulsars
A.8 Plugins 259
A.8.9 Quasars
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + Alt + Q Show quasars
A.8.10 Satellites
Shortcut key Description
Ctrl + Z Toggle satellite hints
Alt + Shift + Z Toggle satellite labels
Alt + Z Toggle Satellites configuration window
Alt + 6 Move telescope #6 to the point currently in the center of the screen
Alt + 7 Move telescope #7 to the point currently in the center of the screen
Alt + 8 Move telescope #8 to the point currently in the center of the screen
Alt + 9 Move telescope #9 to the point currently in the center of the screen
The Bortle scale is a nine-level numeric scale that measures the night sky’s brightness of a particular
location. It quantifies the astronomical observability of celestial objects and the interference
caused by light pollution. J OHN E. B ORTLE created the scale and published it in Sky & Telescope
magazine (Bortle, 2001) to help amateur astronomers evaluate the darkness of an observing site,
and secondarily, to compare the darkness of observing sites. The scale ranges from Class 1, the
darkest skies available on Earth, through Class 9, inner-city skies. It gives several criteria for each
level beyond naked-eye limiting magnitude (NELM). The accuracy and utility of the scale have
been questioned in recent research (Crumey, 2014).
This chapter provides technical descriptions on how Stellarium records its star catalogues, and the
related file formats.
n = 20 · 4L (C.1)
Stellarium uses levels 0 to 7 in the existing star catalogues. Star Data Records contain the
position of a star as an offset from the central position of the zone in which that star is located, thus
it is necessary to determine the vector from the observer to the centre of a zone, and add the star’s
offsets to find the absolute position of the star on the celestial sphere.
This position for a star is expressed as a 3-dimensional vector which points from the observer
(at the centre of the geodesic sphere) to the position of the star as observed on the celestial sphere.
stars_2_0v0_7.cat
stars_3_1v0_4.cat
stars_4_1v0_2.cat
stars_5_2v0_1.cat
stars_6_2v0_1.cat
stars_7_2v0_1.cat
stars_8_2v0_1.cat
There also exist some control and reference files:
stars_hip_cids_0v0_0.cat
stars_hip_sp_0v0_3.cat
gcvs_hip_part.dat
wds_hip_part.dat
cross-id.dat
stars.ini
name.fab
When Stellarium starts, it reads the stars.ini file, from which it determines the names of the
other files, which it then loads.
The files stars_hip_cids_0v0_0.cat and stars_hip_sp_0v0_2.cat contain reference
data for the main catalogue files. The file gcvs_hip_part.dat contains data about variables stars
(see section C.3) and file wds_hip_part.dat contains data about double stars (see section C.4)
which again contains references into the main catalogue files.
The file cross-id.dat (see section C.5) contains cross-identification data between HIP, SAO,
HD and HR designations.
A given catalogue file models stars for one and only one level (i.e. for a fixed number of zones),
which is recorded in the header of the file. Individual star records do not contain full positional
coordinates, instead they contain coordinates relative to the central position of the zone they occupy.
Thus, when parsing star catalogues, it is necessary to know about the zone model to be able to
extract positional data.
File Data Data Geodesic #Records Notes
Type Record Size Level
stars_0_0v0_7.cat 0 28 bytes 0 4,979 Hipparcos
stars_1_0v0_7.cat 0 28 bytes 1 21,806 Hipparcos
stars_2_0v0_7.cat 0 28 bytes 2 150,850 Hipparcos
stars_3_1v0_4.cat 1 10 bytes 3 425,807 Tycho 2
stars_4_1v0_2.cat 1 10 bytes 4 1,692,779 Tycho 2
stars_5_2v0_1.cat 2 8 bytes 5 7,083,058 NOMAD
stars_6_2v0_1.cat 2 8 bytes 6 24,670,782 NOMAD
stars_7_2v0_1.cat 2 8 bytes 7 50,733,321 NOMAD
stars_8_2v0_1.cat 2 8 bytes 7 92,304,337 NOMAD
For a given catalogue file, there may be one of three formats for the actual star data. The
variation comes from the source of the data – the larger catalogues of fainter stars providing less
data per star than the brighter star catalogues. See tables Stellarium’s star catalogue and for details.
Stellarium’s star catalogues are based on Hipparcos (Anderson and Francis, 2012; ESA, 1997),
Tycho 2 (Høg et al., 2000) and NOMAD (Zacharias et al., 2004) catalogues.
Zone Records
The Zone Records section of the file lists the number of star records there are per zone. The number
of zones is determined from the level value in the File Header Record, as described in section
268 Appendix C. Star Catalogues
Zones. The Zones section is simply a list of integer values which describe the number of stars for
each zone. The total length of the Zones section depends on the number of zones. See table C.2.
File Format
The gcvs_hip_part.dat file contains data about 6916 Variable Stars (see section 18.2.5) which
have HIP identificators and are stored in a plain text format with tab delimiter (Table C.6).
1 http://www.sai.msu.su/gcvs/gcvs/
270 Appendix C. Star Catalogues
stars), emission lines [Si II] and [O I], as well as the absorption line Li I 6707 A.
These variables are usually observed only in diffuse nebulae. If it is not apparent
that the star is associated with a nebula, the letter “N” in the symbol for the type
may be omitted, e.g., IT (RW AUR);
IN(YY) Some Orion variables (YY Ori) show the presence of absorption components
on the redward sides of emission lines, indicating the infall of matter toward the
stars’ surfaces. In such cases, the symbol for the type may be accompanied by
the symbol “YY”.
IS Rapid irregular variables having no apparent connection with diffuse nebulae and showing
light changes of about 0.5 - 1.0 mag within several hours or days. There is no strict
boundary between rapid irregular and Orion variables. If a rapid irregular star is
observed in the region of a diffuse nebula, it is considered an Orion variable and
designated by the symbol INS. To attribute a variable to the IS type, it is necessary
to take much care to be certain that its light changes are really not periodic. Quite a
number of the stars assigned to this type in the third edition of the GCVS turned out
to be eclipsing binary systems, RR Lyrae variables, and even extragalactic BL Lac
objects.
ISA Rapid irregular variables of the early spectral types, B-A or Ae;
ISB Rapid irregular variables of the intermediate and late spectral types, F-M and
Fe-Me.
RCB Variables of the R Coronae Borealis type. These are hydrogen-poor, carbon- and helium-
rich, high-luminosity stars belonging to the spectral types Bpe-R, which are simultaneously
eruptive and pulsating variables. They show slow nonperiodic fadings by 1-9 mag in V
lasting from a month or more to several hundred days. These changes are superposed on
cyclic pulsations with amplitudes up to several tenths of a magnitude and periods in the
range 30-100 days.
RS Eruptive variables of the RS Canum Venaticorum type. This type is ascribed to close binary
systems with spectra showing Ca II H and K in emission, their components having enhanced
chromospheric activity that causes quasi-periodic light variability. The period of variation
is close to the orbital one, and the variability amplitude is usually as great as 0.2 mag in V
(UX Ari). They are X-ray sources and rotating variables. RS CVn itself is also an eclipsing
system (see below).
SDOR Variables of the S Doradus type. These are eruptive, high-luminosity Bpec-Fpec stars
showing irregular (sometimes cyclic) light changes with amplitudes in the range 1-7 mag in
V. They belong to the brightest blue stars of their parent galaxies. As a rule, these stars are
connected with diffuse nebulae and surrounded by expanding envelopes (P Cyg, Eta Car).
UV Eruptive variables of the UV Ceti type, these are K Ve-M Ve stars sometimes displaying flare
activity with amplitudes from several tenths of a magnitude up to 6 mag in V. The amplitude
is considerably greater in the ultraviolet spectral region. Maximum light is attained in several
seconds or dozens of seconds after the beginning of a flare; the star returns to its normal
brightness in several minutes or dozens of minutes.
UVN Flaring Orion variables of spectral types Ke-Me. These are phenomenologically almost
identical to UV Cet variables observed in the solar neighborhood. In addition to being related
to nebulae, they are normally characterized by being of earlier spectral type and greater
luminosity, with slower development of flares (V389 Ori). They are possibly a specific
subgroup of INB variables with irregular variations superimposed by flares.
WR Eruptive Wolf-Rayet variables. Stars with broad emission features of He I and He II as well as
C II-C IV, O II-O IV, and N III-N V. They display irregular light changes with amplitudes up
to 0.1 mag in V, which are probably caused by physical processes, in particular, by nonstable
C.3 Variable Stars 273
belong to the young disk population. DCEP stars are present in open clusters. They display
a certain relation between the shapes of their light curves and their periods.
DCEPS These are Delta Cep variables having light amplitudes <0.5 mag in V (<0.7 mag
in B) and almost symmetrical light curves (M-m approx. 0.4 - 0.5 periods); as a rule,
their periods do not exceed 7 days. They are probably first-overtone pulsators and/or
are in the first transition across the instability strip after leaving the main sequence
(SU Cas).
Traditionally, both Delta Cep and W Vir stars are quite often called Cepheids because
it is often impossible to discriminate between them on the basis of the light curves for
periods in the range 3 - 10 days. However, these are distinct groups of entirely different
objects in different evolutionary stages. One of the significant spectral differences
between W Vir stars and Cepheids is the presence, during a certain phase interval, of
hydrogen-line emission in the former and of Ca II H and K emission in the latter.
DSCT Variables of the Delta Scuti type. These are pulsating variables of spectral types A0-F5
III-V displaying light amplitudes from 0.003 to 0.9 mag in V (usually several hundredths of
a magnitude) and periods from 0.01 to 0.2 days. The shapes of the light curves, periods, and
amplitudes usually vary greatly. Radial as well as nonradial pulsations are observed. The
variability of some members of this type appears sporadically and sometimes completely
ceases, this being a consequence of strong amplitude modulation with the lower value of
the amplitude not exceeding 0.001 mag in some cases. The maximum of the surface layer
expansion does not lag behind the maximum light for more than 0.1 periods. DSCT stars are
representatives of the galactic disk (flat component) and are phenomenologically close to the
SX Phe variables.
DSCTC Low amplitude group of Delta Sct variables (light amplitude <0.1 mag in V). The
majority of this type’s representatives are stars of luminosity class V; objects of this
subtype generally are representative of the Delta Sct variables in open clusters.
GDOR Gamma Doradus stars. Early type F dwarfs showing (multiple) periods from several
tenths of a day to slightly in excess of one day. Amplitudes usually do not exceed 0.1 mag.
Presumably low degree g-mode non-radial pulsators. Prototype: gamma Dor.
L Slow irregular variables. The light variations of these stars show no evidence of periodicity, or
any periodicity present is very poorly defined and appears only occasionally. Like for the
type I, stars are often attributed to this type because of being insufficiently studied. Many
type L variables are really semiregulars or belong to other types.
LB Slow irregular variables of late spectral types (K, M, C, S); as a rule, they are giants
(CO Cyg). This type is also ascribed, in the GCVS, to slow red irregular variables in
the case of unknown spectral types and luminosities.
LC Irregular variable supergiants of late spectral types having amplitudes of about 1 mag in
V (TZ Cas).
LPB The comparatively long-period pulsating B stars (periods exceeding (LBV) one day).
M Mira (Omicron) Ceti-type variables. These are long-period variable giants with characteristic
late-type emission spectra (Me, Ce, Se) and light amplitudes from 2.5 to 11 mag in V. Their
periodicity is well pronounced, and the periods lie in the range between 80 and 1000 days.
Infrared amplitudes are usually less than in the visible and may be <2.5 mag. For example,
in the K band they usually do not exceed 0.9 mag. If the amplitudes exceed 1 - 1.5 mag , but
it is not certain that the true light amplitude exceeds 2.5 mag, the symbol “M” is followed by
a colon, or the star is attributed to the semiregular class with a colon following the symbol
for that type (SR).
PVTEL Variables of the PV Telescopii type. These are helium supergiant Bp stars with weak
hydrogen lines and enhanced lines of He and C. They pulsate with periods of approximately
C.3 Variable Stars 275
0.1 to 1 days, or vary in brightness with an amplitude of 0.1 mag in V during a time interval
of about a year.
RPHS Very rapidly pulsating hot (subdwarf B) stars. Typical periods are hundreds of seconds,
amplitudes are within several hundredths of a magnitude. Prototype: V361 Hya = EC
14026-2647.
RR Variables of the RR Lyrae type, which are radially-pulsating giant A-F stars having amplitudes
from 0.2 to 2 mag in V. Cases of variable light-curve shapes as well as variable periods are
known. If these changes are periodic, they are called the Blazhko effect.
Traditionally, RR Lyrae stars are sometimes called short-period Cepheids or cluster-type
variables. The majority of these stars belong to the spherical component of the Galaxy; they
are present, sometimes in large numbers, in some globular clusters, where they are known as
pulsating horizontal-branch stars. Like Cepheids, maximum expansion velocities of surface
layers for these stars practically coincide with maximum light.
RR(B) RR Lyrae variables showing two simultaneously operating pulsation modes, the
fundamental tone with the period P0 and the first overtone, P1 (AQ Leo). The ratio
P1/P0 is approximately 0.745;
RRAB RR Lyrae variables with asymmetric light curves (steep ascending branches), periods
from 0.3 to 1.2 days, and amplitudes from 0.5 to 2 mag in V;
RRC RR Lyrae variables with nearly symmetric, sometimes sinusoidal, light curves, periods
from 0.2 to 0.5 days, and amplitudes not greater than 0.8 mag in V (SX UMa).
RV Variables of the RV Tauri type. These are radially pulsating supergiants having spectral types
F-G at maximum light and K-M at minimum. The light curves are characterized by the
presence of double waves with alternating primary and secondary minima that can vary in
depth so that primary minima may become secondary and vice versa. The complete light
amplitude may reach 3-4 mag in V. Periods between two adjacent primary minima (usually
called formal periods) lie in the range 30-150 days (these are the periods appearing in the
Catalogue). Two subtypes, RVA and RVB, are recognized:
RVA RV Tauri variables that do not vary in mean magnitude (AC Her);
RVB RV Tauri variables that periodically (with periods from 600 to 1500 days and ampli-
tudes up to 2 mag in V) vary in mean magnitude (DF Cyg, RV Tau).
SR Semiregular variables, which are giants or supergiants of intermediate and late spectral types
showing noticeable periodicity in their light changes, accompanied or sometimes interrupted
by various irregularities. Periods lie in the range from 20 to >2000 days, while the shapes of
the light curves are rather different and variable, and the amplitudes may be from several
hundredths to several magnitudes (usually 1-2 mag in V).
SRA Semiregular late-type (M, C, S or Me, Ce, Se) giants displaying persistent periodicity
and usually small (<2.5 mag in V) light amplitudes (Z Aqr). Amplitudes and light-
curve shapes generally vary and periods are in the range of 35-1200 days. Many of
these stars differ from Miras only by showing smaller light amplitudes;
SRB Semiregular late-type (M, C, S or Me, Ce, Se) giants with poorly defined periodicity
(mean cycles in the range of 20 to 2300 days) or with alternating intervals of periodic
and slow irregular changes, and even with light constancy intervals (RR CrB, AF Cyg).
Every star of this type may usually be assigned a certain mean period (cycle), which is
the value given in the Catalogue. In a number of cases, the simultaneous presence of
two or more periods of light variation is observed;
SRC Semiregular late-type (M, C, S or Me, Ce, Se) supergiants (Mu Cep) with amplitudes
of about 1 mag and periods of light variation from 30 days to several thousand days;
SRD Semiregular variable giants and supergiants of F, G, or K spectral types, sometimes
with emission lines in their spectra. Amplitudes of light variation are in the range from
276 Appendix C. Star Catalogues
0.1 to 4 mag, and the range of periods is from 30 to 1100 days (SX Her, SV UMa).
SRS Semiregular pulsating red giants with short period (several days to a month), probably
high-overtone pulsators. Prototype: AU Ari.
SXPHE Phenomenologically, these resemble DSCT (Delta Sct) variables and are pulsating subd-
warfs of the spherical component, or old disk galactic population, with spectral types in the
range A2-F5. They may show several simultaneous periods of oscillation, generally in the
range 0.04-0.08 days, with variable-amplitude light changes that may reach 0.7 mag in V.
These stars are present in globular clusters.
ZZ ZZ Ceti variables. These are nonradially pulsating white dwarfs that change their brightnesses
with periods from 30 s to 25 min and amplitudes from 0.001 to 0.2 mag in V. They usually
show several close period values. Flares of 1 mag are sometimes observed; however, these
may be explained by the presence of close UV Ceti companions.
These variables are divided into the following subtypes:
ZZA ZZ Cet-type variables of DA spectral type (ZZ Cet) having only hydrogen absorption
lines in their spectra;
ZZB ZZ Cet-type variables of DB spectral type having only helium absorption lines in their
spectra.
ZZO ZZ Cet-type variables of the DO spectral type showing HeII and and CIV absorpion
lines in their spectra.
and sometimes Halpha. They may also be spectroscopic binary systems. Periods of light
variation (up to several days) are equal to rotational periods, and amplitudes are several
tenths of a magnitude. It is not excluded that these objects are the product of further evolution
of EW (W UMa) close binary systems (see below).
PSR Optically variable pulsars (CM Tau), which are rapidly rotating neutron stars with strong
magnetic fields, radiating in the radio, optical, and X-ray regions. Pulsars emit narrow beams
of radiation, and periods of their light changes coincide with rotational periods (from 0.004
to 4 s), while amplitudes of the light pulses reach 0.8 mag.
R Close binary systems characterized by the presence of strong reflection (re-radiation) of the light
of the hot star illuminating the surface of the cooler companion. Light curves are sinusoidal
with the period equal to Porb, maximum brightness coinciding with the passage of the hot
star in front of the companion. The eclipse may be absent. The range of light variation is
about 0.5-1.0mag V (KV Vel).
SXARI SX Arietis-type variables. These are main-sequence B0p-B9p stars with variable-intensity
He I and Si III lines and magnetic fields. They are sometimes called helium variables.
Periods of light and magnetic field changes (about 1 day) coincide with rotational periods,
while amplitudes are approximately 0.1 mag in V. These stars are high-temperature analogs
of the ACV variables.
Her is not taken into account: The rate of fading is estimated on the basis of a smooth
curve, its parts before and after the “dip” being a direct continuation of one another;
NC Novae with a very slow development and remaining at maximum light for more than
a decade, then fading very slowly. Before an outburst these objects may show long-
period light changes with amplitudes of 1-2 mag in V (RR Tel); cool components of
these systems are probably giants or supergiants, sometimes semiregular variables,
and even Mira variables. Outburst amplitudes may reach 10 mag. High excitation
emission spectra resemble those of planetary nebulae, Wolf-Rayet stars, and symbiotic
variables. The possibility that these objects are planetary nebulae in the process of
formation is not excluded;
NL Novalike variables, which are insufficiently studied objects resembling novae by the
characteristics of their light changes or by spectral features. This type includes, in
addition to variables showing novalike outbursts, objects with no bursts ever observed;
the spectra of novalike variables resemble those of old novae, and small light changes
resemble those typical for old novae at minimum light. However, quite often a
detailed investigation makes it possible to reclassify some representatives of this highly
inhomogeneous group of objects into other types;
NR Recurrent novae, which differ from typical novae by the fact that two or more outbursts
(instead of a single one) separated by 10-80 years have been observed (T CrB).
SN Supernovae (B Cas, CM Tau). Stars that increase, as a result of an outburst, their brightnesses
by 20 mag and more, then fade slowly. The spectrum during an outburst is characterized
by the presence of very broad emission bands, their widths being several times greater than
those of the bright bands observed in the spectra of novae. The expansion velocities of SN
envelopes are in the thousands of km/s. The structure of a star after outburst alters completely.
An expanding emission nebula results and a (not always observable) pulsar remains at the
position of the original star. According to the light curve shape and the spectral features,
supernovae are subdivided into types I and II.
SNI Type I supernovae. Absorption lines of Ca II, Si, etc., but no hydrogen lines are present
in the spectra. The expanding envelope almost lacks hydrogen. During 20-30 days
following maximum light, the brightness decreases by approximately 0.1 mag per day,
then the rate of fading slows and reaches a constant value of 0.014/day;
SNII Type II supernovae. Lines of hydrogen and other elements are apparent in their
spectra. The expanding envelope consists mainly of H and He. Light curves show
greater diversity than those of type I supernovae. Usually after 40-100 days since
maximum light, the rate of fading is 0.1 mag per day.
UG U Geminorum-type variables, quite often called dwarf novae. They are close binary systems
consisting of a dwarf or subgiant K-M star that fills the volume of its inner Roche lobe and a
white dwarf surrounded by an accretion disk. Orbital periods are in the range 0.05-0.5 days.
Usually only small, in some cases rapid, light fluctuations are observed, but from time to
time the brightness of a system increases rapidly by several magnitudes and, after an interval
of from several days to a month or more, returns to the original state. Intervals between two
consecutive outbursts for a given star may vary greatly, but every star is characterized by a
certain mean value of these intervals, i.e., a mean cycle that corresponds to the mean light
amplitude. The longer the cycle, the greater the amplitude. These systems are frequently
sources of X-ray emission. The spectrum of a system at minimum is continuous, with broad
H and He emission lines. At maximum these lines almost disappear or become shallow
absorption lines. Some of these systems are eclipsing, possibly indicating that the primary
minimum is caused by the eclipse of a hot spot that originates in the accretion disk from the
infall of a gaseous stream from the K-M star. According to the characteristics of the light
C.3 Variable Stars 279
changes, U Gem variables may be subdivided into three types: SS Cyg, SU UMa, and Z
Cam.
UGSS SS Cygni-type variables (SS Cyg, U Gem). They increase in brightness by 2-6 mag
in V in 1-2 days and in several subsequent days return to their original brightnesses.
The values of the cycle are in the range 10 days to several thousand;
UGSU SU Ursae Majoris-type variables. These are characterized by the presence of two
types of outbursts called “normal” and “supermaxima”. Normal, short outbursts
are similar to those of UGSS stars, while supermaxima are brighter by 2 mag, are
more than five times longer (wider), and occur several times less frequently. During
supermaxima the light curves show superposed periodic oscillations (superhumps),
their periods being close to the orbital ones and amplitudes being about 0.2-0.3 mag in
V. Orbital periods are shorter than 0.1 days; companions are of dM spectral type;
UGZ Z Camelopardalis-type stars. These also show cyclic outbursts, differing from UGSS
variables by the fact that sometimes after an outburst they do not return to the original
brightness, but during several cycles retain a magnitude between maximum and mini-
mum. The values of cycles are from 10 to 40 days, while light amplitudes are from 2
to 5 mag in V.
ZAND Symbiotic variables of the Z Andromedae type. They are close binaries consisting of a hot
star, a star of late type, and an extended envelope excited by the hot star’s radiation. The
combined brightness displays irregular variations with amplitudes up to 4 mag in V. A very
inhomogeneous group of objects.
Optically Variable Close Binary Sources of Strong, Variable X-ray Radiation (X-ray
Sources)
AM AM Her type variables; close binary systems consisting of a dK-dM type dwarf and of a
compact object with strong magnetic field, characterized by variable linear and circular
polarization of light. The total range of light variations may reach 4-5 mag V.
X Close binary systems that are sources of strong, variable X-ray emission and which do not
belong to or are not yet attributed to any of the above types of variable stars. One of the
components of the system is a hot compact object (white dwarf, neutron star, or possibly a
black hole). X-ray emission originates from the infall of matter onto the compact object or
onto an accretion disk surrounding the compact object. In turn, the X-ray emission is incident
upon the atmosphere of the cooler companion of the compact object and is reradiated in the
form of optical high-temperature radiation (reflection effect), thus making that area of the
cooler companion’s surface an earlier spectral type. These effects lead to quite a peculiar
complex character of optical variability in such systems. These objects may be subdivided
into the following types:
XB X-ray bursters. Close binary systems showing X-ray and optical bursts, their duration
being from several seconds to ten minutes, with amplitudes of about 0.1 mag in V (V
801 Ara, V 926 Sco);
XF Fluctuating X-ray systems showing rapid variations of X-ray (Cygnus X-1 = V1357
Cyg) and optical (V821 Ara) radiation on time scalesof dozens of milliseconds;
XI X-ray irregulars. Close binary systems consisting of a hot compact object surrounded by
an accretion disk and a dA - dM-type dwarf. These display irregular light changes on
time scales of minutes and hours, and amplitudes of about 1 mag in V. Superposition
of a periodic variation because of orbital motion is possible (V818 Sco);
XJ X-ray binaries characterized by the presence of relativistic jets evident at X-ray and radio
wavelengths, as well as in the optical spectrum in the form of emission components
showing periodic displacements with relativistic velocities (V1343 Aql);
XND X-ray, novalike (transient) systems containing, along with a hot compact object, a
dwarf or subgiant of G-M spectral type. These systems occasionally rapidly increase
in brightness by 4-9 mag in V, in the visible simultaneously with the X-ray range, with
no envelope ejected. The duration of the outburst may be up to several months (V616
Mon);
XNG X-ray, novalike (transient) systems with an early-type supergiant or giant primary
component and a hot compact object as a companion. Following the main component’s
outburst, the material ejected by it falls onto the compact object and causes, with a
significant delay, the appearance of X rays. The amplitudes are about 1-2 mag in V
(V725 Tau);
XP X-ray pulsar systems. The primary component is usually an ellipsoidal early-type
supergiant. The reflection effect is very small and light variability is mainly caused by
the ellipsoidal primary component’s rotation. Periods of light changes are between
1 and 10 days; the period of the pulsar in the system is from 1 s to 100 min. Light
amplitudes usually do not exceed several tenths of a magnitude (Vela X-1 = GP Vel);
XPR X-ray pulsar systems featuring the presence of the reflection effect. They consist of a
dB-dF-type primary and an X-ray pulsar, which may also be an optical pulsar. The
mean light of the system is brightest when the primary component is irradiated by X
rays; it is faintest during a low state of the X-ray source. The total light amplitude may
reach 2-3 mag in V (HZ Her);
XPRM,XM X-ray systems consisting of a late-type dwarf (dK-dM) and a pulsar with a
strong magnetic field. Matter accretion on the compact object’s magnetic poles is
282 Appendix C. Star Catalogues
Other Symbols
In addition to the variable-star types described above, certain other symbols that need to be explained
will be found in the Type data field:
BLLAC Extragalactic BL Lacertae-type objects. These are compact quasistellar objects showing
almost continuous spectra with weak emission and absorption lines and relatively rapid
irregular light changes with amplitudes up to 3 mag in V or more. Sources of strong X-ray
radiation and radio waves, their emission displays strong and variable linear polarization in
the visible and infrared spectral regions. Some objects of this type, considered erroneously to
be variable stars and designated in the GCVS system, will probably sometimes be included
in the main table of the Catalogue in the future, too.
CST Nonvariable stars, formerly suspected to be variable and hastily designated. Further observa-
tions have not confirmed their variability.
GAL Optically variable quasistellar extragalactic objects (active galactic nuclei [AGNs]) consid-
ered to be variable stars by mistake.
L: Unstudied variable stars with slow light changes.
QSO Optically variable quasistellar extragalactic sources (quasars) that earlier were erroneously
considered to be variable stars.
S Unstudied variable stars with rapid light changes.
* Unique variable stars outside the range of the classifications described above. These probably
represent either short stages of transition from one variability type to another or the earliest
and latest evolutionary stages of these types, or they are insufficiently studied members of
future new types of variables.
+ If a variable star belongs to several types of light variability simultaneously, the types are joined
in the Type field by a “+” sign (e.g., E+UG, UV+BY).
: Uncertainty flag on Type of Variability
3 http://ad.usno.navy.mil/wds/
C.5 Cross-Identification Data 283
File Format
The wds_hip_part.dat file contains data about 16411 double stars which have HIP identificators
and stored in plain text format with tab delimiters.
File Format
The file cross-id.dat contains cross reference data for catalogues HIP, SAO, HD and HR, which
stored in the plain text format with tab delimiter.
D.1.2 astrocalc
This section includes settings for the Astronomical Calculations feature.
D.1.3 color
This section defines the RGB colors for the various objects, lines, grids, labels etc. Values are given
in float from 0 to 1. e.g. 1.0,1.0,1.0 for white, or 1,0,0 for red. Leave no whitespace between the
numbers!
D.1.4 custom_selected_info
You can fine-tune the bits of information to display for the selected object in this section. Set the
entry to true to display it.
ID Type Description
flag_show_absolutemagnitude bool absolute magnitude for objects.
flag_show_altaz bool horizontal coordinates for objects.
flag_show_catalognumber bool catalog designations for objects.
flag_show_distance bool distance to object.
flag_show_extra bool extra info for object.
flag_show_hourangle bool hour angle for object.
flag_show_magnitude bool magnitude for object.
flag_show_name bool common name for object.
flag_show_radecj2000 bool equatorial coordinates (J2000.0 frame) of object.
flag_show_radecofdate bool equatorial coordinates (of date) of object.
flag_show_galcoord bool galactic coordinates (System II) of object.
flag_show_supergalcoord bool supergalactic coordinates of object.
flag_show_eclcoordj2000 bool ecliptic coordinates (J2000.0 frame) of object.
flag_show_eclcoordofdate bool ecliptic coordinates (of date) of object.
flag_show_type bool type of object.
flag_show_size bool size of object.
flag_show_sidereal_time bool sidereal time.
flag_show_rts_time bool rise, transit and set times.
flag_show_velocity bool velocity of object.
flag_show_constellation bool show 3-letter IAU constellation label.
D.1 Program Configuration 293
D.1.5 custom_time_correction
Stellarium allows experiments with ∆T . See 17.4.3 for details.
ID Type Description
coefficients [float,float,float] Coefficients a, b, c for custom equation of ∆T
ndot float n-dot value for custom equation of ∆T
year int Year for custom equation of ∆T
D.1.6 devel
This section is for developers only.
ID Type Description
convert_dso_catalog bool Set to true to convert file catalog.txt into file
catalog.dat. Default value: false.
convert_dso_decimal_coord bool Set to true to use decimal values for coordinates in source
catalog. Default value: true.
D.1.7 dso_catalog_filters
In this section you can fine-tune which of the deep-sky catalogs should be selected on startup.
D.1.9 gui
This section includes settings for the graphical user interface. See sections 4.3.3–4.3.5 for most of
these keys.
D.1.10 init_location
ID Type Description
landscape_name string Sets the landscape you see. Built-in options are garching, geneva,
grossmugl, guereins, hurricane, jupiter, mars, moon, neptune, ocean,
saturn, trees, uranus, zero.
location string Name of location on which to start stellarium.
last_location string Coordinates of last used location in stellarium.
D.1.11 landscape
ID Type Description
atmosphere_fade_duration float Sets the time (seconds) it takes for the atmosphere to
fade when de-selected
flag_landscape bool Set to false if you don’t want to see the landscape at
all
flag_fog bool Set to false if you don’t want to see fog on start-up
flag_atmosphere bool Set to false if you don’t want to see atmosphere on
start-up
2 Scroll by dragging in the window directly, not a slider handle. Scrolling stops after a short time.
D.1 Program Configuration 297
flag_landscape_sets_location bool Set to true if you want Stellarium to modify the ob-
server location when a new landscape is selected
(changes planet and longitude/latitude/altitude if lo-
cation data is available in the landscape.ini file)
minimal_brightness float Set minimal brightness for landscapes. [0. . . 1] Typi-
cal value: 0.01
atmosphereybin int Set atmosphere binning coefficient for axis Y.
flag_minimal_brightness bool Set to true to use minimal brightness for landscape.
flag_landscape_sets_minimal_brightness bool Set to true to use value for minimal brightness for
landscape from landscape settings.
flag_enable_illumination_layer bool Set to true to use illumination layer for landscape.
flag_enable_labels bool Set to true to use landscape labels from gazetteer
layer.
atmospheric_extinction_coefficient float Set atmospheric extinction coefficient k [mag/air-
mass]
temperature_C float Set atmospheric temperature [Celsius]
pressure_mbar float Set atmospheric pressure [mbar]
cache_size_mb int Set the cache size for landscapes [megabytes]. De-
fault: 100
D.1.12 localization
ID Type Description
sky_culture string Sets the sky culture to use. E.g. western, polynesian, egyptian,
chinese, lakota, navajo, inuit, korean, norse, tupi, maori, aztec,
sami.
sky_locale string Sets language used for names of objects in the sky (e.g. planets).
The value is a short locale code, e.g. en, de, en_GB
app_locale string Sets language used for Stellarium’s user interface. The value is
a short locale code, e.g. en, de, en_GB.
time_zone string Sets the time zone. Valid values: system_default, or some
region/location combination, e.g. Pacific/Marquesas
time_display_format string time display format: can be system_default, 24h or 12h.
date_display_format string date display format: can be system_default, mmddyyyy, ddm-
myyyy or yyyymmdd (ISO8601).
298 Appendix D. Configuration Files
D.1.13 main
ID Type Description
invert_screenshots_colors bool If true, Stellarium will saving the screenshorts with in-
verted colors.
screenshot_dir string Path for saving screenshots
screenshot_format string File format. One of png|jpg|jpeg|tif|tiff|
webp|pbm|pgm|ppm|xbm|xpm|ico
screenshot_custom_size bool true if you want to specify particular dimensions next:
screenshot_custom_width int custom width of screenshots. Max. available size is hard-
ware dependent!
screenshot_custom_height int custom height of screenshots. Max. available size is hard-
ware dependent!
version string Version of Stellarium. This parameter may be used to
detect necessary changes in config.ini file, do not edit.
use_separate_output_file bool Set to true if you want to create a new file for script output
for each start of Stellarium
restore_defaults bool If true, Stellarium will restore default settings at
startup. This is equivalent to calling Stellarium with the
–restore-defaults option.
ignore_opengl_warning bool Set to true if you don’t want to see OpenGL warnings for
each start of Stellarium.
check_requirements bool Set to false if you want to disable and permanently ig-
nore checking hardware requirements at startup. Expect
problems if hardware is below requirements!
geoip_api_url string URL for JSON interface of GeoIP service.
D.1.14 navigation
This section controls much of the look&feel of Stellarium. Be careful if you change something
here.
ID Type Description
preset_sky_time float Preset sky time used by the dome version. Unit is
Julian Day. Typical value: 2451514.250011573
startup_time_mode string Set the start-up time mode, can be actual (start
with current real world time), or Preset (start at
time defined by preset_sky_time)
flag_enable_zoom_keys bool Set to false if you want to disable the zoom
flag_manual_zoom bool Set to false for normal zoom behaviour as described
in this guide. When set to true, the auto zoom
feature only moves in a small amount and must be
pressed many times
flag_enable_move_keys bool Set to false if you want to disable the arrow keys
flag_enable_mouse_navigation bool Set to false if you want to disable the mouse navi-
gation.
init_fov float Initial field of view, in degrees, typical value: ”60”.
min_fov float Minimal field of view, in degrees, typical value:
”0.001389” (5").
D.1 Program Configuration 299
D.1.15 plugins_load_at_startup
This section lists which plugins are loaded at startup (those with true values). Each plugin can
add another section into this file with its own content, which is described in the respective plugin
documentation, see 11. You activate loading of plugins in the F2 settings dialog, tab “Plugins”.
After selection of which plugins to load, you must restart Stellarium.
ID Type Description
AngleMeasure bool 12.1 Angle Measure plugin
ArchaeoLines bool 13.9 ArchaeoLines plugin
CompassMarks bool 12.2 Compass Marks plugin
MeteorShowers bool 13.6 Meteor Showers plugin
Exoplanets bool 13.3 Exoplanets plugin
Observability bool 15.7 Observability Analysis
Oculars bool 15.1 Oculars plugin
Pulsars bool 13.4 Pulsars plugin
Quasars bool 13.5 Quasars plugin
RemoteControl bool 12.7 Remote Control plugin
RemoteSync bool 12.8 Remote Sync plugin
Satellites bool 13.8 Satellites plugin
SolarSystemEditor bool 12.9 Solar System Editor plugin
Supernovae bool 13.2 Historical Supernovae plugin
TelescopeControl bool 15.2 Telescope Control plugin
TextUserInterface bool 12.6 Text User Interface plugin
Novae bool 13.1 Bright Novae plugin
Scenery3dMgr bool 14 Scenery 3D plugin
300 Appendix D. Configuration Files
D.1.16 projection
This section contains the projection of your choice and several advanced settings important if you
run Stellarium on a single screen, multi-projection, dome projection, or other setups.
ID Type Description
type string Sets projection mode. Values: ProjectionPerspective,
ProjectionEqualArea, ProjectionStereographic, Pro-
jectionFisheye, ProjectionHammer, ProjectionCylin-
der, ProjectionMercator, ProjectionOrthographic,
ProjectionMiller, or ProjectionSinusoidal.
flip_horz bool
flip_vert bool
viewport string How the view-port looks. Values: none (regular rect-
angular screen), disk (circular screen, useful for plan-
etarium setup).
viewportMask string How the view-port looks. Values: none.
viewport_fov_diameter float
viewport_x float Usually 0.
viewport_y float Usually 0.
viewport_width float
viewport_height float
viewport_center_x float Usually half of viewport_width.
viewport_center_y float Usually half of viewport_height.
viewport_center_offset_x float [-0.5. . . +0.5] Usually 0.
viewport_center_offset_y float [-0.5. . . +0.5] Use negative values to move the hori-
zon lower.
D.1.17 proxy
This section has setting for connection to network through proxy server (proxy will be using when
host of proxy is filled).
ID Type Description
host_name string Name of host for proxy. E.g. proxy.org
type string Type of proxy. E.g. socks
port int Port of proxy. E.g. 8080
user string Username for proxy. E.g. michael_knight
password string Password for proxy. E.g. xxxxx
D.1 Program Configuration 301
D.1.18 scripts
ID Type Default Description
startup_script string startup.ssc name of script executed on pro-
gram start
flag_script_allow_write_absolute_path bool false set true to let scripts store files
to absolute pathnames. This
may pose a security risk if you
run scripts from other authors
without checking what they are
doing.
D.1.19 search
ID Type Description
flag_search_online bool If true, Stellarium will be use SIMBAD for search.
simbad_server_url string URL for SIMBAD mirror
flag_start_words bool If false, Stellarium will be search phrase only from start of words
coordinate_system string Specifies the coordinate system. Possible values: equatorialJ2000,
equatorial, horizontal, galactic. Default value: equatorialJ2000.
D.1.20 spheric_mirror
Stellarium can be used in planetarium domes. You can use a projector with a hemispheric mirror
with geometric properties given in this section. Note: These functions are only rarely used or tested,
some may not work as expected.
D.1.21 stars
ID Type Description
relative_scale float relative size of bright and faint stars. Higher values mean that
bright stars are comparitively larger when rendered. Typical
value: 1.0
absolute_scale float Changes how large stars are rendered. larger value lead to
larger depiction. Typical value: 1.0
star_twinkle_amount float amount of twinkling. Typical value: 0.3
flag_star_twinkle bool true to allow twinkling (but only when atmosphere is active!).
flag_forced_twinkle bool true to allow twinkling stars even without atmosphere. This
is obvious nonsense and contrary to nature, but some users
seem to like it.
flag_star_halo bool false to not draw a halo around the brightest stars. This looks
poor, but some users seem to prefer it.
mag_converter_max_fov float maximum field of view for which the magnitude conversion
routine is used. Typical value: 90.0.
mag_converter_min_fov float minimum field of view for which the magnitude conversion
routine is used. Typical value: 0.001.
labels_amount float amount of labels. Typical value: 3.0
init_bortle_scale int initial value of light pollution on the Bortle scale. Typical
value: 3.
D.1.22 tui
The built-in text user interface (TUI) plugin (see chapter 12.6) is most useful for planetariums. You
can even configure a system shutdown command. For historical reasons, the section is not called
[TextUserInterface] but simply [tui].
D.1 Program Configuration 303
D.1.23 video
ID Type Description
fullscreen bool If true, Stellarium will start up in full-screen mode, else windowed
mode
screen_w int Display width when in windowed mode. Value in pixels, e.g. 1024
screen_h int Display height when in windowed mode. Value in pixels, e.g. 768
screen_x int Horizontal position of the top-left corner in windowed mode. Value
in pixels, e.g. 0
screen_y int Vertical position of the top-left corner in windowed mode. Value in
pixels, e.g. 0
viewport_effect string This is used when the spheric mirror display mode is activated. Values
include none and sphericMirrorDistorter.
minimum_fps int Sets the minimum number of frames per second to display at (hard-
ware performance permitting)
maximum_fps int Sets the maximum number of frames per second to display at. This
is useful to reduce power consumption in laptops.
D.1.24 viewing
This section defines which objects, labels, lines, grids etc. you want to see on startup. Set those to
true. Most items can be toggled with hotkeys or switched in the GUI.
ID Type Description
flag_asterism_drawing bool Display asterism line drawing
flag_asterism_name bool Display asterism names
flag_rayhelper_drawing bool Display the ray helper line drawing
flag_constellation_drawing bool Display constellation line drawing
flag_constellation_name bool Display constellation names
flag_constellation_art bool Display constellation art
flag_constellation_boundaries bool Display constellation boundaries
flag_constellation_isolate_selected bool If true, constellation lines, boundaries and art will
be limited to the constellation of the selected star,
if that star is “on” one of the constellation lines.
304 Appendix D. Configuration Files
flag_constellation_pick bool Set to true if you only want to see the line drawing,
art and name of the selected constellation star
flag_isolated_trails bool Set to true if you only want to see the trail line
drawn for the selected planet (asteroid, comet,
moon)
flag_isolated_orbits bool Set to true if you want to see orbits only for selected
planet and their moons.
flag_azimutal_grid bool Display azimuthal grid
flag_equatorial_grid bool Display equatorial grid (of date)
flag_equatorial_J2000_grid bool Display equatorial grid (J2000)
flag_ecliptic_grid bool Display ecliptic grid (of date)
flag_ecliptic_J2000_grid bool Display ecliptic grid (J2000)
flag_galactic_grid bool Display galactic grid (System II)
flag_galactic_equator_line bool Display galactic equator line
flag_equator_line bool Display celestial equator line (of date)
flag_equator_J2000_line bool Display celestial equator line (J2000)
flag_ecliptic_line bool Display ecliptic line (of date)
flag_ecliptic_J2000_line bool Display ecliptic line (J2000)
flag_meridian_line bool Display meridian line
flag_prime_vertical_line bool Display Prime Vertical line (East-Zenith-West)
flag_colure_lines bool Display colure lines (Celestial Pole-à/ã/æ/é)
flag_cardinal_points bool Display cardinal points
cardinal_font_size int Font size for cardinal points. Typical value: 24
subcardinal_font_size int Font size for subcardinal points. Typical value: 18
flag_gravity_labels bool Set to true if you want labels to undergo gravity
(top side of text points toward zenith). Useful with
dome projection.
flag_moon_scaled bool Keep it false if you want to see the real moon size
moon_scale float Sets the moon scale factor, sometimes useful to cor-
relate to our perception of the moon’s size. Typical
value: 4
flag_minorbodies_scaled bool Set to true if you want to see minor bodies enlarged
minorbodies_scale float Set scale factor for minor bodies, to see them in
unnatural detail. Typical value: 10
constellation_art_intensity float brightness [0. . . 1] of the constellation art images.
Typical value: 0.5
constellation_art_fade_duration float time the constellation art takes to fade in or out, in
seconds. Typical value: 1.5
constellation_font_size int font size for constellation labels
constellation_line_thickness int thickness of constellation lines [1. . . 5]. Typical
value: 1
asterism_font_size int font size for asterism labels
asterism_line_thickness int thickness of the asterism lines [1. . . 5]. Typical
value: 1
rayhelper_line_thickness int thickness of the ray helper lines [1. . . 5]. Typical
value: 1
D.1 Program Configuration 305
D.1.25 DialogPositions
By default, GUI panels appear centered in the screen. You can move them to your favorite location,
and on next start they will appear on that location instead. The entries in this section define the
upper left pixel coordinate where panels are stored.
Examples:
ID Type Example Description
Help int,int 58,39 Position of Help panel
DateTime int,int 1338,944 Position of time panel
D.1.26 DialogSizes
v0.15.1
GUI panels can be resized by dragging on their lower corners or borders. Enlarged sizes are stored
here, and on next start they will appear in this size. The entries in this section define the size.
Examples:
ID Type Example Description
Help int,int 895,497 Size of Help panel
AstroCalc int,int 913,493 Size of AstroCalc panel
D.1.27 hips
This section defines the source list of the HiPS surveys, as well as other HiPS related options. v0.18.0
ID Type Description
show bool show HiPS at startup?
sources/size int Number of HiPS survey sources
sources/n/url string uri of the nth source hipslist file (n ∈ [1 . . . sources/size])
visible/url bool HiPS configured to be displayed. (Stores current setting on program
exit)
306 Appendix D. Configuration Files
albedo =0.51
atmosphere =1
color =1. , 0.983 , 0.934
tex_map = jupiter . png # texture courtesy of Bj \ xf6rn J \ xf3nsson
halo = true
oblateness =0.064874
orbit_v i su al iz a ti on _p e ri od =4331.87
parent = Sun
radius =71492
rot_equ a to r_ as c en di ng _ no de = -22.203
rot_obliquity =2.222461
rot_periode =9.92491
rot_pole_de =64.49
rot_pole_ra =268.05
rot_rotation_offset = -1 # use JupiterGRS patch
where
name English name of the planet. May appear translated.
type Mandatory for planets:
parent =Sun. The body which this object is running around. Default: Sun
coord_func The planet positions are all computed with a dedicated function (VSOP or DE43x).
3 Before v0.16, there was a single file, ssystem.ini, with slightly different rules.
D.2 Solar System Configuration Files 307
orbit_visualization_period number of (earth) days for how long the orbit should be made visible.
Typically Stellarium shows one orbit line. The orbit slowly drifts, however.
atmosphere (0 or 1) flag to indicate whether observer locations should enable atmosphere drawing.
radius Equator radius, km.
oblateness Flattening of the polar diameter. (r pole /req )
albedo total albedo (reflectivity) of the planet. Used for “generic” magnitude computation, but
the major planets usually have dedicated magnitude formulas, so the value is not evaluated
unless you are observing from a location outside Earth.
color Used to colorize halo. At least one of the components should be 1.
tex_halo File name of texture map for halo texture in textures folder. (Used when zoomed out
far enough so that the actual sphere is not visible.)
tex_map File name of texture map in textures folder.
halo Should be true to draw a halo (simple light disk) when object too small to draw a sphere.
These cases are covered by the data in ssystem_major.ini. Other cases are dealt with in a
different way.
Moon section
All planet moons are defined only in ssystem_major.ini.
Moons are special in that they orbit another planet. Therefore, the rotational elements used to
be specified relative to the equatorial plane of the parent planet, and orbit_SemiMajorAxis are
specified in kilometers. However, current IAU reference material gives axis orientation with right
ascension and declination values for the pole in ICRF coordinates, with some of them in motion.
So again, if one of the rot_pole_... values exist, we assume the current standard. For more
complicated motion, again some special functions are applied.
[ amalthea ]
name = Amalthea
type = moon
parent = Jupiter
iau_moon_number = JV
308 Appendix D. Configuration Files
coord_func = ell_orbit
orbit_AscendingNode =141.5521520794674
orbit_Eccentricity =0.006175744402949701
orbit_Epoch =2454619.50000
orbit_Inclination =0.3864576103404582
orbit_LongOfPericenter =245.4222355150120000
orbit_MeanLongitude =224.7924893552550000
orbit_Period =0.5016370462116355
orbit_SemiMajorAxis =181994.8658358799
orbit_v i su al iz a ti on _p e ri od =0.5016370462116355
radius =73
rot_equ a to r_ as c en di ng _ no de =213.7
rot_obliquity =15.5
rot_periode =12.039289109079252
rot_rotation_offset =235.50
albedo =0.06
color =1. , 0.627 , 0.492
halo = true
tex_map = amalthea . png
model = j5amalthea_MLfix . obj
where
name English name of planet moon. No number, just the name. May be translated.
type moon
parent English name of planet or parent body.
iau_moon_number a short label (string) consisting of the planet’s initial and the moon’s Roman
v0.16.1 number in order of discovery.
coord_func Must be ell_orbit for moons with orbital elements given, or <name>_special for
orbit_AscendingNode Ω
orbit_Eccentricity e
orbit_Epoch
orbit_Inclination i [degrees]
orbit_LongOfPericenter
orbit_MeanLongitude
orbit_Period [days]
orbit_SemiMajorAxis a [km]
orbit_visualization_period [days] Defaults to orbit_Period to show orbit as closed line. This
is in fact only useful in case of special functions for positioning where orbit_Period is
not given.
radius Equator radius, km.
oblateness Flattening of the polar diameter. (r pole /req )
rot_equator_ascending_node =213.7 TRY TO AVOID!
rot_obliquity =15.5 TRY TO AVOID!
rot_pole_ra constant of axis right ascension in ICRF, degrees
rot_pole_ra1 change per century of axis right ascension in ICRF, degrees
rot_pole_de constant of axis declination in ICRF, degrees
D.2 Solar System Configuration Files 309
Note the inclination and mean longitude of 90 degrees, and that it is hidden and has no halo.
Earth Observer
This is another “observer” location. The Earth Observer has been provided as a neutral view
location above the Northern hemisphere of the Earth. It has been configured like this:
[ earth_observer ]
name = Earth Observer
parent = Earth
albedo =0.
color =0. , 0. , 0.
halo = false
hidden = true
310 Appendix D. Configuration Files
coord_func = ell_orbit
orbit_AscendingNode =0
orbit_Eccentricity =0
orbit_Epoch =2451545.0
orbit_Inclination =43
orbit_LongOfPericenter =0
orbit_MeanLongitude =90
orbit_Period =100000000000
orbit_SemiMajorAxis =1000000
radius =1.
rot_obliquity =90
type = observer
[4 vesta ]
type = asteroid
minor_planet_number =4
name = Vesta
coord_func = comet_orbit
parent = Sun
orbit_ArgOfPericenter =151.19843
orbit_AscendingNode =103.85141
orbit_Eccentricity =0.0887401
orbit_Epoch =2457000.5
orbit_Inclination =7.14043
orbit_MeanAnomaly =20.86389
orbit_MeanMotion =0.27154465
orbit_SemiMajorAxis =2.3617933
orbit_v i su al iz a ti on _p e ri od =1325.46
color =1. , 1. , 1.
halo = true
oblateness =0.0
albedo =0.423
radius =280
absolute_magnitude =3.2
slope_parameter =0.32
tex_map = vesta . png
model =4 vesta_21_MLfix . obj
type can be asteroid, dwarf planet, cubewano, plutino, scattered disc object,
Oort cloud object. With the exception of Pluto (which is included in ssystem_major.ini
and cannot be changed), all positions for minor bodies are computed with the orbiting elements
given in this way.
D.2 Solar System Configuration Files 311
Note that although all minor planets orbit the sun in an elliptical orbit, the coord_func=comet_orbit.
However, it is more common for minor planets to specify epoch, mean anomaly and mean motion.
Visual magnitude is modelled from absolute magnitude H and slope parameter G.
Elements for rotational axis may be given just like for planets when they are known. It is
recommended to use the modern specification (elements rot_pole_...).
A few asteroids have been visited by spacecraft, and for many other asteroids visual observations v0.16.0
of stellar occultations by asteroids and light curve measurements have enabled researchers to derive
3D shape models of asteroids. If a model is available in the models subdirectory of the program
directory, this can be configured with a model entry.
Comet section
Comets are tiny, and their outgassing and close approaches to the major planets cause fast changes
in their orbital elements, so that each apparition should be specified with a dedicated section in
ssystem_minor.ini.
The coord_func is always specified as comet_orbit. Note the specification of a time (JDE) at
pericenter which is typical for comets.
Comet brightness is evaluated from
The term slope_parameter may be a misnomer in case of comets. From the literature (Meeus,
1998) (equation 33.13) we find
from which κ = 2 · slope_parameter. In any case, κ is typically [5. . . 15] and specific for each
comet.
albedo is used to set the brightness for rendering the body, if you are close enough.
A large number of elements for historical comets is provided in the file ssystem_1000comets.ini
in the installation directory. You can copy&paste what you need into your ssystem_minor.ini
or add all with the Solar System Editor plugin (section 12.9). Unfortunately it is not possible to
specify several sets of orbital elements for different epochs of one apparition which would allow
automatic changes.
Periodic Comet
[1 phalley ]
type = comet
name =1 P / Halley
coord_func = comet_orbit
parent = Sun [ can be omitted ]
orbit_ArgOfPericenter =111.7154
orbit_AscendingNode =58.8583
orbit_Eccentricity =0.968004
orbit_Inclination =162.2453
orbit_Peri cent erD ista nce =0.57136
orbit_TimeAtPericenter =2446463.12979167
orbit_good =780
312 Appendix D. Configuration Files
albedo =0.1
radius =5
absolute_magnitude =5.5
slope_parameter =3.2
tex_map = nomap . png
model =1682 q1halley_MLfix . obj [ optional ]
You may want to e.g. change the name in this entry to name=1P/Halley (1982i). Note a
rather short duration of orbit_good, which means the comet is only displayed 780 days before
and after perihel.
Some comets have been visited by spacecraft so that shape models of their cores may be
v0.16.0 available and can be configured with a model entry.
Parabolic/Hyperbolic Comet
[ c2013us10 %28 catalina %29]
type = comet
name = C /2013 US10 ( Catalina )
coord_func = comet_orbit
parent = Sun
orbit_ArgOfPericenter =340.3533
orbit_AscendingNode =186.141
orbit_Eccentricity =1.000372
orbit_Inclination =148.8766
orbit_Peri cent erD ista nce =0.822958
orbit_TimeAtPericenter =2457342.20748843
orbit_good =1000
albedo =0.1
radius =5
absolute_magnitude =4.4
slope_parameter =4
tex_map = nomap . png
This has basically the same format. Note eccentricity is larger 1, this means the comet is
running on a slightly hyperbolic orbit. Stellarium shows data for this comet for almost 3 years
(orbit_good=1000 days) from perihel.
E. Planetary nomenclature
v0.17.0
Planetary nomenclature, like terrestrial nomenclature, is a system of uniquely identifying features
on the surface of a planet or natural satellite so that the features can be easily located, described, and
discussed. Since the invention of the telescope, astronomers have given names to the surface features
they have discerned, especially on the Moon and Mars. To standardize planetary nomenclature, the
International Astronomical Union (IAU) was assigned in 1919 the task of selecting official names
for features on solar system bodies1 .
Since version 0.17.0 Stellarium supports planetary nomenclature, which allows using the
planetarium for educational and informative purposes on the one hand, and as tool for recognition
and targeting of the planetary features for advanced amateurs on the other hand, avoiding the need
for additional cartographic software in the field.
All planetary nomenclature items are stored in a dedicated internal format, and all names are
translatable to provide better understanding of those names by average users and newbies – for
example in schools or universities. Of course all nomenclature items are available for finding in
the Search Tool after enabling the display of nomenclature (this feature is rather costly in terms of
computing power and therefore is by default disabled in the GUI).
The information in sections E.2–E.5, included here for reference, has been taken from the
“Gazetteer of Planetary Nomenclature” website by the International Astronomical Union (IAU)
Working Group for Planetary System Nomenclature (WGPSN)2 .
Example:
Vesta 15201 _ ( " Caesonia " ," crater " ) AA 31.20117 249.93457 104.23
submitted to the IAU Working Group for Planetary System Nomenclature (WGPSN)3 . Upon
successful review by the members of the WGPSN, names are considered provisionally approved
and can be used on maps and in publications as long as the provisional status is clearly stated.
Provisional names are then presented for adoption to the IAU’s General Assembly, which met
triennially in the past, and which now adopts nomenclature for planetary surface features as required.
A name is not considered to be official – that is, “adopted” – until the General Assembly has given
its approval.
12. Accessible and authoritative sources, including Internet sources, are required for adopted
names. Wikipedia is not sufficient as a source, but may be useful for identifying appropriate
sources.
In addition to these general rules, each task group develops additional conventions as it formulates an
interesting and meaningful nomenclature for individual planetary bodies. Most of these conventions
are self evident from study of the appendixes that follow.
Stellarium originally was developed to present a beautiful simulation of the night sky, mostly
to understand what is visible in the sky when you leave your house, i.e., for present times. To
save computation time, some concessions were made in astronomical accuracy by using simplified
models which seemed acceptable at that time. However, many users started to overstress Stellarium’s
capabilities to simulate the historical sky of many centuries in the past, and found — or even worse:
did not find, but simply published — the resulting inconsistencies and errors. Unfortunately, celestial
motions are indeed more complicated than a simple clockwork, and the process of retrofitting
detailed and accurate models which started around v0.11.0 is not completed yet. Therefore, when
using Stellarium for scientific work like eclipse simulation to illustrate records found in Cuneiform
tablets, always also use some other reference to compare, and of course specify the program version
you used for your work. (The next version may be more accurate or at least provide different
results!) You can of course contact us if you are willing and able to help improving Stellarium’s
accuracy!
could be simulated. Still, the simulation here should give a good impression which close and/or
fast stars will move over time, and thus how constellations become deformed.
Note that due to the way the stars are stored in catalogs, zooming in on fast stars like Arcturus
may even cease to display such stars when their original area in the sky is no longer in view.
Also, binary stars seem to break apart because Stellarium does not store them as systems
revolving about their combined center of gravity.
These known deficits were also identified in a recent study (De Lorenzis and Orofino, 2018),
which emphasized errors with Arcturus, Dubhe, Sirius, Toliman and Vega which already deviate
noticably from their correct locations around 2500BC. If you need accurate stellar positions for
earlier prehistory from a free and open-source program, it seems only Cartes du Ciel currently
can be recommended as on a par with the best available solutions.
F.7 Eclipses
The moon’s motion is very complicated, and eclipse computations can be tricky. One aspect which
every student of history, prehistory and archaeology should know but as it seems not every does,
is at least a basic understanding of the irregular slow-down of earth’s rotation known as ∆T (see
section 17.4.3).
Eclipse records on cuneiform tablets go back to the 8th century BC, some Chinese records go
back a bit further. Experts on Earth rotation have provided models for ∆T based on such observa-
tions. These are usually given as parabolic fit, with some recommended time span. Extrapolating
parabolic fits to erratic curves too far into the past is dangerous, pointless and inevitably leads to
errors or invalid results. Models differ by many hours (exceeding a whole day!) when applied too
far in the past. This means, there was certainly an eclipse, and latitude will be OK, but you cannot
say which longitude the eclipse was covering. The probability to have seen a total eclipse at a
certain interesting location will be very small and should by itself not be used as positive argument
for any reasonable statement. This is not a problem of Stellarium, but of current knowledge. To
repeat, you may find a solar eclipse in the 6th millennium BC, but you cannot even be sure which
side of Earth could observe it!
WANTED: A model for ∆T that works in the Mesolithic!
a leap day every fourth year, which is a bit too much. If you want to show summer solstice in
the year -2500, you will notice it is not on June 21st. This is not an error of Stellarium – the
Gregorian reform had a reason! In prehistoric times, it may be more useful to work with solar
ecliptic longitudes. For example, summer solstice is at λ = 90◦ .
J ULIUS C AESAR introduced a Solar calendar to the Roman empire in 46 BC but was assassi-
nated in March 44 BC=-43 (see below). His simple 4-year leap rule was then misapplied by the
high priests of Rome by adding a leap day every third year. AUGUSTUS fixed the calendar, and only
8 AD was the first correctly applied leap year as we know them (Ginzel, 1908, §186, §189). Be
careful if you are working in Augustean and earlier times in the Roman world, maybe even related
to named dates in the pre-Julian Roman calendar: Stellarium does not model these issues! Better
find independent conversion methods to Julian Day Number (JD), and use that.
Some authors (esp. for Mesoamerican dates) give dates in the proleptic Gregorian calendar
(which means, they apply the Gregorian leap year rules before 1582). This is a convention, they may
of course do that, but you must do the conversion to the Julian calendar to visualize the sky with
Stellarium. Hopefully they also give Julian Day numbers (JD), you can use them with Stellarium.
JD numbers are independent from calendar systems.
Some have noted a difference of one between dates given as BC versus Stellarium’s negative
years. Note that historical chronology does not know a year Zero! (Try to write this date in Roman
numbers!) Year 1 AD was preceded by year 1 BC. Astronomers want to simplify computations
and therefore use a year 0 (equivalent to 1 BC). It is simple: 1 BC=0, 2 BC=-1, . . . . 100 BC=-99.
Stellarium is an astronomy program. Just accept this.
G. GNU Free Documentation License
G.1 PREAMBLE
The purpose of this License is to make a manual, textbook, or other functional and useful document
“free” in the sense of freedom: to assure everyone the effective freedom to copy and redistribute it,
with or without modifying it, either commercially or noncommercially. Secondarily, this License
preserves for the author and publisher a way to get credit for their work, while not being considered
responsible for modifications made by others.
This License is a kind of “copyleft”, which means that derivative works of the document must
themselves be free in the same sense. It complements the GNU General Public License, which is a
copyleft license designed for free software.
We have designed this License in order to use it for manuals for free software, because free
software needs free documentation: a free program should come with manuals providing the same
freedoms that the software does. But this License is not limited to software manuals; it can be used
for any textual work, regardless of subject matter or whether it is published as a printed book. We
recommend this License principally for works whose purpose is instruction or reference.
public is a licensee, and is addressed as “you”. You accept the license if you copy, modify or
distribute the work in a way requiring permission under copyright law.
A “Modified Version” of the Document means any work containing the Document or a portion
of it, either copied verbatim, or with modifications and/or translated into another language.
A “Secondary Section” is a named appendix or a front-matter section of the Document that deals
exclusively with the relationship of the publishers or authors of the Document to the Document’s
overall subject (or to related matters) and contains nothing that could fall directly within that overall
subject. (Thus, if the Document is in part a textbook of mathematics, a Secondary Section may
not explain any mathematics.) The relationship could be a matter of historical connection with the
subject or with related matters, or of legal, commercial, philosophical, ethical or political position
regarding them.
The “Invariant Sections” are certain Secondary Sections whose titles are designated, as being
those of Invariant Sections, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License.
If a section does not fit the above definition of Secondary then it is not allowed to be designated as
Invariant. The Document may contain zero Invariant Sections. If the Document does not identify
any Invariant Sections then there are none.
The “Cover Texts” are certain short passages of text that are listed, as Front-Cover Texts or
Back-Cover Texts, in the notice that says that the Document is released under this License. A
Front-Cover Text may be at most 5 words, and a Back-Cover Text may be at most 25 words.
A “Transparent” copy of the Document means a machine-readable copy, represented in a
format whose specification is available to the general public, that is suitable for revising the
document straightforwardly with generic text editors or (for images composed of pixels) generic
paint programs or (for drawings) some widely available drawing editor, and that is suitable for
input to text formatters or for automatic translation to a variety of formats suitable for input to
text formatters. A copy made in an otherwise Transparent file format whose markup, or absence
of markup, has been arranged to thwart or discourage subsequent modification by readers is not
Transparent. An image format is not Transparent if used for any substantial amount of text. A copy
that is not “Transparent” is called “Opaque”.
Examples of suitable formats for Transparent copies include plain ASCII without markup,
Texinfo input format, LaTeX input format, SGML or XML using a publicly available DTD, and
standard-conforming simple HTML, PostScript or PDF designed for human modification. Examples
of transparent image formats include PNG, XCF and JPG. Opaque formats include proprietary
formats that can be read and edited only by proprietary word processors, SGML or XML for which
the DTD and/or processing tools are not generally available, and the machine-generated HTML,
PostScript or PDF produced by some word processors for output purposes only.
The “Title Page” means, for a printed book, the title page itself, plus such following pages as
are needed to hold, legibly, the material this License requires to appear in the title page. For works
in formats which do not have any title page as such, “Title Page” means the text near the most
prominent appearance of the work’s title, preceding the beginning of the body of the text.
The “publisher” means any person or entity that distributes copies of the Document to the
public.
A section “Entitled XYZ” means a named subunit of the Document whose title either is precisely
XYZ or contains XYZ in parentheses following text that translates XYZ in another language.
(Here XYZ stands for a specific section name mentioned below, such as “Acknowledgements”,
“Dedications”, “Endorsements”, or “History”.) To “Preserve the Title” of such a section when you
modify the Document means that it remains a section “Entitled XYZ” according to this definition.
The Document may include Warranty Disclaimers next to the notice which states that this
License applies to the Document. These Warranty Disclaimers are considered to be included by
reference in this License, but only as regards disclaiming warranties: any other implication that
G.3 VERBATIM COPYING 325
these Warranty Disclaimers may have is void and has no effect on the meaning of this License.
G.5 MODIFICATIONS
You may copy and distribute a Modified Version of the Document under the conditions of sections
2 and 3 above, provided that you release the Modified Version under precisely this License, with
the Modified Version filling the role of the Document, thus licensing distribution and modification
of the Modified Version to whoever possesses a copy of it. In addition, you must do these things in
the Modified Version:
• A. Use in the Title Page (and on the covers, if any) a title distinct from that of the Document,
and from those of previous versions (which should, if there were any, be listed in the History
326 Appendix G. GNU Free Documentation License
section of the Document). You may use the same title as a previous version if the original
publisher of that version gives permission.
• B. List on the Title Page, as authors, one or more persons or entities responsible for authorship
of the modifications in the Modified Version, together with at least five of the principal
authors of the Document (all of its principal authors, if it has fewer than five), unless they
release you from this requirement.
• C. State on the Title page the name of the publisher of the Modified Version, as the publisher.
• D. Preserve all the copyright notices of the Document.
• E. Add an appropriate copyright notice for your modifications adjacent to the other copyright
notices.
• F. Include, immediately after the copyright notices, a license notice giving the public
permission to use the Modified Version under the terms of this License, in the form shown in
the Addendum below.
• G. Preserve in that license notice the full lists of Invariant Sections and required Cover Texts
given in the Document’s license notice.
• H. Include an unaltered copy of this License.
• I. Preserve the section Entitled “History”, Preserve its Title, and add to it an item stating at
least the title, year, new authors, and publisher of the Modified Version as given on the Title
Page. If there is no section Entitled “History” in the Document, create one stating the title,
year, authors, and publisher of the Document as given on its Title Page, then add an item
describing the Modified Version as stated in the previous sentence.
• J. Preserve the network location, if any, given in the Document for public access to a
Transparent copy of the Document, and likewise the network locations given in the Document
for previous versions it was based on. These may be placed in the “History” section. You
may omit a network location for a work that was published at least four years before the
Document itself, or if the original publisher of the version it refers to gives permission.
• K. For any section Entitled “Acknowledgements” or “Dedications”, Preserve the Title of
the section, and preserve in the section all the substance and tone of each of the contributor
acknowledgements and/or dedications given therein.
• L. Preserve all the Invariant Sections of the Document, unaltered in their text and in their
titles. Section numbers or the equivalent are not considered part of the section titles.
• M. Delete any section Entitled “Endorsements”. Such a section may not be included in the
Modified Version.
• N. Do not retitle any existing section to be Entitled “Endorsements” or to conflict in title
with any Invariant Section.
• O. Preserve any Warranty Disclaimers.
If the Modified Version includes new front-matter sections or appendices that qualify as
Secondary Sections and contain no material copied from the Document, you may at your option
designate some or all of these sections as invariant. To do this, add their titles to the list of Invariant
Sections in the Modified Version’s license notice. These titles must be distinct from any other
section titles.
You may add a section Entitled “Endorsements”, provided it contains nothing but endorsements
of your Modified Version by various parties — for example, statements of peer review or that the
text has been approved by an organization as the authoritative definition of a standard.
You may add a passage of up to five words as a Front-Cover Text, and a passage of up to
25 words as a Back-Cover Text, to the end of the list of Cover Texts in the Modified Version.
Only one passage of Front-Cover Text and one of Back-Cover Text may be added by (or through
arrangements made by) any one entity. If the Document already includes a cover text for the same
cover, previously added by you or by arrangement made by the same entity you are acting on behalf
G.6 COMBINING DOCUMENTS 327
of, you may not add another; but you may replace the old one, on explicit permission from the
previous publisher that added the old one.
The author(s) and publisher(s) of the Document do not by this License give permission to use
their names for publicity for or to assert or imply endorsement of any Modified Version.
G.9 TRANSLATION
Translation is considered a kind of modification, so you may distribute translations of the Document
under the terms of section 4. Replacing Invariant Sections with translations requires special permis-
sion from their copyright holders, but you may include translations of some or all Invariant Sections
in addition to the original versions of these Invariant Sections. You may include a translation of
this License, and all the license notices in the Document, and any Warranty Disclaimers, provided
that you also include the original English version of this License and the original versions of those
notices and disclaimers. In case of a disagreement between the translation and the original version
of this License or a notice or disclaimer, the original version will prevail.
If a section in the Document is Entitled “Acknowledgements”, “Dedications”, or “History”, the
requirement (section 4) to Preserve its Title (section 1) will typically require changing the actual
title.
G.10 TERMINATION
You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Document except as expressly provided
under this License. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute it is void, and
will automatically terminate your rights under this License.
However, if you cease all violation of this License, then your license from a particular copyright
holder is reinstated (a) provisionally, unless and until the copyright holder explicitly and finally
terminates your license, and (b) permanently, if the copyright holder fails to notify you of the
violation by some reasonable means prior to 60 days after the cessation.
Moreover, your license from a particular copyright holder is reinstated permanently if the
copyright holder notifies you of the violation by some reasonable means, this is the first time you
have received notice of violation of this License (for any work) from that copyright holder, and you
cure the violation prior to 30 days after your receipt of the notice.
Termination of your rights under this section does not terminate the licenses of parties who
have received copies or rights from you under this License. If your rights have been terminated and
not permanently reinstated, receipt of a copy of some or all of the same material does not give you
any rights to use it.
G.12 RELICENSING
“Massive Multiauthor Collaboration Site” (or “MMC Site”) means any World Wide Web server
that publishes copyrightable works and also provides prominent facilities for anybody to edit
G.12 RELICENSING 329
those works. A public wiki that anybody can edit is an example of such a server. A “Massive
Multiauthor Collaboration” (or “MMC”) contained in the site means any set of copyrightable works
thus published on the MMC site.
“CC-BY-SA” means the Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 license published by
Creative Commons Corporation, a not-for-profit corporation with a principal place of business in
San Francisco, California, as well as future copyleft versions of that license published by that same
organization.
“Incorporate” means to publish or republish a Document, in whole or in part, as part of another
Document.
An MMC is “eligible for relicensing” if it is licensed under this License, and if all works
that were first published under this License somewhere other than this MMC, and subsequently
incorporated in whole or in part into the MMC, (1) had no cover texts or invariant sections, and (2)
were thus incorporated prior to November 1, 2008.
The operator of an MMC Site may republish an MMC contained in the site under CC-BY-SA
on the same site at any time before August 1, 2009, provided the MMC is eligible for relicensing.
H. Acknowledgements
H.1 Contributors
When not listed as chapter authors, the following were the main contributors to the User Guide,
mostly for versions before V0.15:
Matthew Gates Primary author of the first User Guide (versions 0.9
to 0.12)
Paul Robinson Sky guide; exercise ideas
Andras Mohari Celestial sphere diagrams; numerous corrections
Rudy Gobits, Dirk Schwarzhans Mac platform specifics
Barry Gerdes † Windows platform specifics
Customisation of .fab files
Documentation Maintainer up to V0.12
Sigma Japanese translation; many corrections
Richard Powell Figure 18.3 (colour/magnitude diagram) is a modifi-
cation of his diagram; he kindly granted permission
for it to be distributed under the FDL
John Twin Many spelling corrections
Georg Zotti Lead author of the 0.15+ editions
Alexander Wolf New layout, many contributions for the 0.15+ edi-
tions
The rest of the Stellarium developer team You know who you are. . . :-)
Additional material has been incorporated into the guide from sources that are published under
the GNU FDL, including material from Wikipedia and the Astronomy book at Wikibooks.
Precession: “New precession expressions, valid for long time intervals” (Vondrák, Capitaine, and
Wallace, 2011) with correction (Vondrák, Capitaine, and Wallace, 2012)
Nutation: “An abridged model of the precession-nutation of the celestial pole” (McCarthy and
Luzum, 2003) This model provides accuracy better than 1 milli-arcsecond in the time
1995-2050. It is applied for years 1500..2500 only.
H.5 Data
1. The Hipparcos star catalog From ESA (European Space Agency) and the Hipparcos mission.
ref. ESA, 1997, The Hipparcos and Tycho Catalogues, ESA SP-1200 http://cdsweb.
u-strasbg.fr/ftp/cats/I/239
2. The solar system data mainly comes from IMCCE and partly from Celestia.
3. Polynesian constellations are based on diagrams from the Polynesian Voyaging Society
4. Chinese constellations are based on diagrams from the Hong Kong Space Museum
5. Egyptian constellations are based on the work of Juan Antonio Belmonte, Instituto de
Astrofisica de Canarias
6. The Tycho-2 Catalogue of the 2.5 Million Brightest Stars Hog E., Fabricius C., Makarov
V.V., Urban S., Corbin T., Wycoff G., Bastian U., Schwekendiek P., Wicenec A. Astron.
Astrophys. 355, L27 (2000) http://cdsweb.u-strasbg.fr/ftp/cats/I/259
7. Naval Observatory Merged Astrometric Dataset (NOMAD) version 1 (http://www.nofs.
navy.mil/nomad) Norbert Zacharias writes:
“There are no fees, both UCAC and NOMAD are freely available with
the only requirement that the source of the data (U.S. Naval Observatory) and
original product name need to be provided with any distribution, as well as a
description about any changes made to the data, if at all.”
The changes made to the data are:
• try to compute visual magnitude and color from the b,v,r values
• compute nr_of_measurements = thenumbero f validb, v, rvalues
• throw away or keep stars (depending on magnitude, nr_of_measurements, combination
of flags, tycho2 number)
• add all stars from Hipparcos (incl. component solutions), and tycho2+1st supplement
• reorganize the stars in several brigthness levels and triangular zones according to
position and magnitude
334 Appendix H. Acknowledgements
The programs that are used to generate the star files are called "MakeCombinedCatalogue",
"ParseHip", "ParseNomad", and can be found in the util subdirectory in source code. The
position, magnitudes, and proper motions of the stars coming from NOMAD are unchanged,
except for a possible loss of precision, especially in magnitude. When there is no v-
magnitude, it is estimated from r or b magnitude. When there is no b- or v- magnitude, the
color B-V is estimated from the other magnitudes. Also proper motions of faint stars are
neglected at all.
8. Stellarium’s Catalog of Variable Stars based on General Catalog of Variable Stars (GCVS)
version 2013Apr. http://www.sai.msu.su/gcvs/gcvs/ Samus N.N., Durlevich O.V.,
Kazarovets E V., Kireeva N.N., Pastukhova E.N., Zharova A.V., et al., General Catalogue
of Variable Stars (Samus+ 2007-2012) http://cdsarc.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/Cat?
cat=B%2Fgcvs&
9. Consolidated DSO catalog was created from various data:
(a) NGC/IC data taken from SIMBAD Astronomical Database http://simbad.u-strasbg.
fr
(b) Distance to NGC/IC data taken from NED (NASA/IPAC EXTRAGALACTIC DATABASE)
http://ned.ipac.caltech.edu
(c) Catalogue of HII Regions (Sharpless, 1959) taken from VizieR http://vizier.
u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/20
(d) H-α emission regions in the Southern Milky Way (Rodgers+, 1960) taken from VizieR
http://vizier.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/216
(e) Catalogue of Reflection Nebulae (Van den Bergh, 1966) taken from VizieR http:
//vizier.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/21
(f) Lynds’ Catalogue of Dark Nebulae (LDN) (Lynds, 1962) taken from VizieR http:
//vizier.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/7A
(g) Lynds’ Catalogue of Bright Nebulae (Lynds, 1965) taken from VizieR http://
vizier.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/9
(h) Catalog of bright diffuse Galactic nebulae (Cederblad, 1946) taken from VizieR
http://vizier.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/231
(i) Barnard’s Catalogue of 349 Dark Objects in the Sky (Barnard, 1927) taken from
VizieR http://vizier.u-strasbg.fr/viz-bin/VizieR?-source=VII/220A
(j) A Catalogue of Star Clusters shown on Franklin-Adams Chart Plates (Melotte, 1915)
taken from NASA ADS http://adsabs.harvard.edu/abs/1915MmRAS..60..175M
(k) On Structural Properties of Open Galactic Clusters and their Spatial Distribution.
Catalog of Open Galactic Clusters (Collinder, 1931). Taken from NASA ADS http:
//adsabs.harvard.edu/abs/1931AnLun...2....1C
(l) The Collinder Catalog of Open Star Clusters. An Observer’s Checklist. Edited
by Thomas Watson. Taken from CloudyNights http://www.cloudynights.com/
page/articles/cat/articles/the-collinder-catalog-updated-r2467
10. Cross-identification of objects in consolidated DSO catalog was maked with:
(a) SIMBAD Astronomical Database http://simbad.u-strasbg.fr
(b) Merged catalogue of reflection nebulae (Magakian, 2003) http://vizier.u-strasbg.
fr/viz-bin/VizieR-3?-source=J/A+A/399/141
(c) Messier Catalogue was taken from Wikipedia (includes morphological classification
and distances) https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/List_of_Messier_objects
(d) Caldwell Catalogue was taken from Wikipedia (includes morphological classification
and distances) https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Caldwell_catalogue
11. Morphological classification and magnitudes (partially) for Melotte catalogue was taken
from DeepSkyPedia http://deepskypedia.com/wiki/List:Melotte
H.6 Image Credits 335
(http://www.madpc.co.uk/~peterv/).
• Image of IC434 from Marc Aragnou.
• Images of IC59, IC63, IC410, NGC2359, Sadr region from Carole Pope (https://sites.
google.com/site/caroleastroimaging/).
• Images of NGC3690, NGC5257, NGC6050, IC883, UGC8335 and UGC9618 from NASA,
ESA, the Hubble Heritage (STScI/AURA)-ESA/Hubble Collaboration. License: public
domain; (http://hubblesite.org/copyright/)
• Images of NGC40, NGC4631, NGC4627, NGC4656, NGC4657 from Steven Bellavia.
• Images of Barnard Loop, IC342 from Sun Shuwei. License: public domain.
• Images of M77, Sh2-264, Sh2-308 from Wang Lingyi. License: public domain.
• Images of IC10 from Lowell Observatory (http://www2.lowell.edu/). License: public
domain.
• Images of IC2177, NGC6334, NGC6357, Fornax Cluster from ESO/Digitized Sky Survey 2
(http://eso.org/public/). License: Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 International.
• Images of NGC3603 from ESO/La Silla Observatory (http://eso.org/public/). Li-
cense: Creative Commons Attribution 4.0 International.
• Images of NGC4244 from Ole Nielsen. License: Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike
2.5 Generic.
• Images of NGC7000 from NASA. License: public domain.
• Images of IC1396 from Giuseppe Donatiello. License: Creative Commons CC0 1.0 Universal
Public Domain Dedication.
• Images of Sh2-155 from Hewholooks (https://commons.wikimedia.org/wiki/). Li-
cense: Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 Unported.
• Images of NGC4565 from Ken Crawford (http://www.imagingdeepsky.com/). License:
“This work is free and may be used by anyone for any purpose. If you wish to use this content,
you do not need to request permission as long as you follow any licensing requirements
mentioned on this page.”
• Images of Coma Cluster from Caelum Observatory (http://www.caelumobservatory.
com/). License: Creative Commons Attribution-Share Alike 3.0 Unported.
• Images of NGC1316 from ESO (http://eso.org/public/). License: Creative Commons
Attribution 4.0 International.
Unless otherwise noted, images and video on JPL public web sites (public sites
ending with a jpl.nasa.gov address) may be used for any purpose without prior
permission, subject to the special cases noted below. Publishers who wish to have
authorization may print this page and retain it for their records; JPL does not issue
image permissions on an image by image basis. By electing to download the material
from this web site the user agrees:
1. that Caltech makes no representations or warranties with respect to ownership
of copyrights in the images, and does not represent others who may claim to be
authors or owners of copyright of any of the images, and makes no warranties
as to the quality of the images. Caltech shall not be responsible for any loss or
expenses resulting from the use of the images, and you release and hold Caltech
harmless from all liability arising from such use.
2. to use a credit line in connection with images. Unless otherwise noted in
the caption information for an image, the credit line should be “Courtesy
NASA/JPL-Caltech.”
3. that the endorsement of any product or service by Caltech, JPL or NASA must
not be claimed or implied.
Special Cases:
• Prior written approval must be obtained to use the NASA insignia logo (the blue
“meatball” insignia), the NASA logotype (the red “worm” logo) and the NASA
seal. These images may not be used by persons who are not NASA employees
or on products (including Web pages) that are not NASA sponsored. In addition,
no image may be used to explicitly or implicitly suggest endorsement by NASA,
JPL or Caltech of commercial goods or services. Requests to use NASA logos
may be directed to Bert Ulrich, Public Services Division, NASA Headquarters,
Code POS, Washington, DC 20546, telephone (202) 358-1713, fax (202) 358-
4331, email bert.ulrich(at)hq.nasa.gov.
• Prior written approval must be obtained to use the JPL logo (stylized JPL letters
in red or other colors). Requests to use the JPL logo may be directed to the
Television/Imaging Team Leader, Media Relations Office, Mail Stop 186-120,
Jet Propulsion Laboratory, Pasadena CA 91109, telephone (818) 354-5011, fax
(818) 354-4537.
• If an image includes an identifiable person, using the image for commercial
purposes may infringe that person’s right of privacy or publicity, and permission
should be obtained from the person. NASA and JPL generally do not permit
likenesses of current employees to appear on commercial products. For more
information, consult the NASA and JPL points of contact listed above.
• JPL/Caltech contractors and vendors who wish to use JPL images in advertising
or public relation materials should direct requests to the Television/Imaging
Team Leader, Media Relations Office, Mail Stop 186-120, Jet Propulsion Labo-
ratory, Pasadena CA 91109, telephone (818) 354-5011, fax (818) 354-4537.
• Some image and video materials on JPL public web sites are owned by orga-
nizations other than JPL or NASA. These owners have agreed to make their
images and video available for journalistic, educational and personal uses, but
restrictions are placed on commercial uses. To obtain permission for commer-
cial use, contact the copyright owner listed in each image caption. Ownership
H.6 Image Credits 339
of images and video by parties other than JPL and NASA is noted in the caption
material with each image.
H.6.3 DSS
From http://archive.stsci.edu/dss/acknowledging.html:
The Digitized Sky Surveys were produced at the Space Telescope Science Institute
under U.S. Government grant NAG W-2166. The images of these surveys are based
on photographic data obtained using the Oschin Schmidt Telescope on Palomar
Mountain and the UK Schmidt Telescope. The plates were processed into the present
compressed digital form with the permission of these institutions.
The National Geographic Society - Palomar Observatory Sky Atlas (POSS-I)
was made by the California Institute of Technology with grants from the National
Geographic Society.
The Second Palomar Observatory Sky Survey (POSS-II) was made by the Cali-
fornia Institute of Technology with funds from the National Science Foundation, the
National Geographic Society, the Sloan Foundation, the Samuel Oschin Foundation,
and the Eastman Kodak Corporation.
The Oschin Schmidt Telescope is operated by the California Institute of Technol-
ogy and Palomar Observatory.
The UK Schmidt Telescope was operated by the Royal Observatory Edinburgh,
with funding from the UK Science and Engineering Research Council (later the UK
Particle Physics and Astronomy Research Council), until 1988 June, and thereafter by
the Anglo-Australian Observatory. The blue plates of the southern Sky Atlas and its
Equatorial Extension (together known as the SERC-J), as well as the Equatorial Red
(ER), and the Second Epoch [red] Survey (SES) were all taken with the UK Schmidt.
All data are subject to the copyright given in the copyright summary1 . Copyright
information specific to individual plates is provided in the downloaded FITS headers.
Supplemental funding for sky-survey work at the ST ScI is provided by the
European Southern Observatory.
1 http://archive.stsci.edu/dss/copyright.html
Bibliography
Abdali, S. Kamal (Sept. 1997). The Correct Quibla (cited on page 151).
Abell, G. O. (Apr. 1966). “Properties of Some Old Planetary Nebulae”. In: The Astrophysi-
cal Journal 144, page 259. DOI: 10.1086/148602 (cited on page 84).
Abell, G. O., H. G. Corwin Jr., and R. P. Olowin (May 1989). “A catalog of rich clusters
of galaxies”. In: Astrophysical Journal Supplement 70, pages 1–138. DOI: 10.1086/
191333 (cited on page 84).
Acker, A. et al. (1992). The Strasbourg-ESO Catalogue of Galactic Planetary Nebulae.
Parts I, II. (Cited on page 84).
Adams, Douglas (1981). The Hitchhiker’s Guide to the Galaxy. Pocket Books (cited on
page 204).
Aller, L. H. et al. (1989). Landolt-Börnstein: Numerical Data and Functional Relationships
in Science and Technology - New Series (cited on page 210).
Anderson, E. and C. Francis (May 2012). “XHIP: An extended hipparcos compilation”. In:
Astronomy Letters 38, pages 331–346. DOI: 10.1134/S1063773712050015. arXiv:
1108.4971 (cited on pages 266, 282, 283).
Arp, H. (Nov. 1966). “Atlas of Peculiar Galaxies”. In: Astrophysical Journal Supplement
14, page 1. DOI: 10.1086/190147 (cited on page 84).
Banjevic, B. (May 2006). “Ancient eclipses and dating the fall of Babylon”. In: Pub-
lications de l’Observatoire Astronomique de Beograd 80, pages 251–257 (cited on
page 209).
Barnard, Edward Emerson (1927). Catalogue of 349 dark objects in the sky (cited on
page 84).
Borkowski, K. M. (Oct. 1988). “ELP 2000-85 and the dynamic time-universal time re-
lation”. In: Astronomy and Astrophysics 205, pages L8–L10 (cited on pages 208,
332).
Bortle, John E. (Feb. 2001). “Introducing the Bortle Dark-Sky Scale”. In: Sky & Tele-
scope, pages 126–129. URL: http://www.skyandtelescope.com/astronomy-
342 BIBLIOGRAPHY
Khalid, M., Mariam Sultana, and Faheem Zaidi (2014). “Delta T: Polynomial Approxi-
mation of Time Period 1620–2013”. In: Journal of Astrophysics 2014. DOI: 10.1155/
2014/480964 (cited on page 209).
Kohoutek, L. (Nov. 2001). “Version 2000 of the Catalogue of Galactic Planetary Nebulae”.
In: Astronomy and Astrophysics 378, pages 843–846. DOI: 10.1051/0004- 6361:
20011162 (cited on page 84).
Kwon, S. M., S. S. Hong, and J. L. Weinberg (2004). “An observational model of the
zodiacal light brightness distribution”. In: New Astronomy 10, pages 91–107. DOI:
doi:10.1016/j.newast.2004.05.004 (cited on page 227).
Larson, Gregory Ward, Holly Rushmeier, and Christine Piatko (Jan. 1997). A Visibility
Matching Tone Reproduction Operator for High Dynamic Range Scenes. Technical
report LBNL-39882, UC-400. Lawrence Berkeley National Laboratory. URL: http:
//radsite.lbl.gov/radiance/papers (cited on page 332).
Lauberts, A. (1982). ESO/Uppsala survey of the ESO(B) atlas (cited on page 84).
Lynds, B. T. (May 1962). “Catalogue of Dark Nebulae.” In: Astrophysical Journal Supple-
ment 7, page 1. DOI: 10.1086/190072 (cited on page 84).
— (Aug. 1965). “Catalogue of Bright Nebulae.” In: Astrophysical Journal Supplement 12,
page 163. DOI: 10.1086/190123 (cited on page 84).
Magakian, T. Y. (Feb. 2003). “Merged catalogue of reflection nebulae”. In: Astronomy and
Astrophysics 399, pages 141–145. DOI: 10.1051/0004-6361:20021743 (cited on
page 84).
Manchester, R. N. et al. (Apr. 2005). “The Australia Telescope National Facility Pulsar
Catalogue”. In: The Astronomical Journal 129, pages 1993–2006. DOI: 10.1086/
428488. eprint: astro-ph/0412641 (cited on page 137).
Mason, B. D. et al. (Dec. 2001). “The 2001 US Naval Observatory Double Star CD-ROM. I.
The Washington Double Star Catalog”. In: The Astronomical Journal 122, pages 3466–
3471. DOI: 10.1086/323920 (cited on page 282).
McCarthy, Dennis D. and Brian J. Luzum (2003). “An abridged model of the precession-
nutation of the celestial pole”. In: Celestial Mechanics and Dynamical Astronomy 85,
pages 37–49 (cited on pages 321, 333).
Meeus, Jean (1988). Astronomical Formulae for Calculators. 4th. Richmond: Willmann-
Bell (cited on page 207).
— (1991). Astronomical Algorithms. Richmond: Willmann-Bell (cited on page 208).
— (1997). Mathematical astronomy morsels. Richmond: Willmann-Bell. ISBN: 0-943396-
51-4 (cited on page 249).
— (1998). Astronomical Algorithms. 2nd. Richmond: Willmann-Bell (cited on pages 208,
311, 332).
— (2002). More mathematical astronomy morsels. Richmond: Willmann-Bell (cited on
page 249).
— (2004). Mathematical astronomy morsels III. Richmond: Willmann-Bell. ISBN: 0-
943396-81-6 (cited on page 249).
Meeus, Jean and L. Simons (Dec. 2000). “Polynomial approximations to Delta T, 1620-
2000 AD”. In: Journal of the British Astronomical Association 110 (cited on pages 208,
209, 332).
Melotte, P. J. (1915). “A Catalogue of Star Clusters shown on Franklin-Adams Chart
Plates”. In: Memoirs of the Royal Astronomical Society 60, page 175 (cited on page 84).
BIBLIOGRAPHY 345
Roman, Nancy (July 1987). “Identification of a Constellation from a Position”. In: Publica-
tions of the Astronomical Society of the Pacific 99, pages 695–699 (cited on pages 111,
219).
Samus, N. N. et al. (2015). “General Catalogue of Variable Stars (Samus+ 2007-2015)”.
In: VizieR On-line Data Catalog B/gcvs, page 1 (cited on page 269).
Schaefer, Bradley (May 1998). “To the Visual Limits”. In: Sky&Telescope, pages 57–60
(cited on page 332).
Schmadel, L. D. and G. Zech (1979). “Polynomial approximations for the correction delta
T E.T.-U.T. in the period 1800-1975”. In: Acta Astronomica 29, pages 101–104 (cited
on pages 207, 332).
— (1988). “Empirical Transformations from U.T. to E.T. for the Period 1800-1988”.
In: Astronomische Nachrichten 309. DOI: 10 . 1002 / asna . 2113090316 (cited on
pages 207, 208, 332).
Schoch, Carl (1931). “Die säkulare Acceleration des Mondes und der Sonne”. In: Astro-
nomische Abhandlungen. Ergänzungshefte zu den Astronomischen Nachrichten 8 (cited
on page 207).
Sharpless, S. (Dec. 1959). “A Catalogue of H II Regions.” In: Astrophysical Journal
Supplement 4, page 257. DOI: 10.1086/190049 (cited on page 84).
Snyder, John P. (1987). Map Projections – A Working Manual. USGS Professional Papers
1395. Washington: U.S. Geological Survey (cited on page 29).
Spencer Jones, H. (May 1939). “The rotation of the earth, and the secular accelerations of
the sun, moon and planets”. In: Monthly Notices of the Royal Astronomical Society 99,
page 541. DOI: 10.1093/mnras/99.7.541 (cited on pages 207, 332).
Stanghellini, Letizia, Richard A. Shaw, and Eva Villaver (Dec. 2008). “The Magellanic
Cloud Calibration of the Galactic Planetary Nebula Distance Scale”. In: The Astrophys-
ical Journal 689, pages 194–202. DOI: 10.1086/592395. arXiv: 0807.1129 (cited on
page 84).
Stephenson, F. R. (1978). “Pre-Telescopic Astronomical Observations”. In: Tidal Friction
and the Earth’s Rotation. Edited by P. Brosche and J. Suendermann, page 5 (cited on
pages 207, 332).
Stephenson, F. R. and L. V. Morrison (Nov. 1984). “Long-term changes in the rotation
of the earth - 700 B.C. to A.D. 1980”. In: Philosophical Transactions of the Royal
Society of London Series A 313, pages 47–70. DOI: 10.1098/rsta.1984.0082 (cited
on pages 207–209, 332).
— (Apr. 1995). “Long-Term Fluctuations in the Earth’s Rotation: 700 BC to AD 1990”.
In: Philosophical Transactions of the Royal Society of London Series A 351, pages 165–
202. DOI: 10.1098/rsta.1995.0028 (cited on pages 208, 332).
Stephenson, F. R., L. V. Morrison, and C. Y. Hohenkerk (Dec. 2016). “Measurement of the
Earth’s rotation: 720 BC to AD 2015”. In: Proc. R. Soc. A 472, page 20160404. DOI:
10.1098/rspa.2016.0404 (cited on page 208).
Stephenson, F. Richard (1997). Historical Eclipses and Earth’s Rotation. Cambridge
Books Online. Cambridge University Press. ISBN: 9780511525186. DOI: 10.1017/
CBO9780511525186. URL: http://ebooks.cambridge.org/ebook.jsf?bid=
CBO9780511525186 (cited on pages 208, 332).
Tuckerman, Bryant (1962). Planetary, Lunar, and Solar Positions, 601 B.C. to A.D. 1, at
Five-day and Ten-day Intervals. Volume 56. American Philosophical Society: Memoirs
BIBLIOGRAPHY 347
Zotti, Georg and Wolfgang Neubauer (Nov. 2012b). “Virtual Reconstructions in a Desktop
Planetarium for Demonstrations in Cultural Astronomy”. In: Progress in Cultural
Heritage Preservation (Proc. 4th International Conference EuroMed 2012, Limassol,
Cyprus, Oct. 29–Nov. 3, 2012). Edited by M. Ioannides et al. Volume 7616. Lecture
Notes in Computer Science. Heidelberg: Springer, pages 170–180. ISBN: 978-3-642-
34233-2 (cited on page 165).
— (2015). “Astronomical and Topographical Orientation of Kreisgrabenanlagen in Lower
Austria”. In: SEAC2011 Stars and Stones: Voyages in Archaeoastronomy and Cultural
Astronomy. Edited by Fernando Pimenta et al. BAR International Series 2720. Oxford:
Archaeopress, pages 188–193. ISBN: 978 1 4073 1373 3 (cited on page 59).
Zotti, Georg, Florian Schaukowitsch, and Michael Wimmer (2017). “The Skyscape Plane-
tarium”. In: The Marriage of Astronomy and Culture: Theory and Method in the Study
of Cultural Astronomy (Papers from the 2016 SEAC Conference). Edited by Liz Henty
et al. Volume 21. Culture and Cosmos 1&2. Lampeter, Ceredigion, Wales: Culture and
Cosmos & Sophia Centre Press, pages 269–281 (cited on page 115).
— (2018). “Beyond 3D Models: Simulation of Phased Models in Stellarium”. In: Mediter-
ranean Archaeology and Archaeometry 18.4, pages 17–24. DOI: 10.5281/zenodo.
1477972. URL: http://maajournal.com/Issues/2018/Vol18- 4/63_Zotti%
20et%20al%2018(4).pdf (cited on pages 161, 165).
Zotti, Georg and Günther Wuchterl (2016). “Raising Awareness of Light Pollution by
Simulation of Nocturnal Light of Astronomical Cultural Heritage Sites”. In: The
Materiality of the Sky. Proceedings of the 22nd Annual SEAC Conference, 2014. Edited
by Fabio Silva et al. Ceredigion, Wales, pages 197–203 (cited on page 80).
Index
A C
absolute magnitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Caesar, Julius . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 321, 322
Adams, Douglas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204 cardinal points . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
air mass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Celestial Equator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
al-Majriti, Abu al-Qasim al-Qurtubi. . . . . .134 Celestial Poles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
al-Saffar, Abu al-Qasim Ahmed Ibn-Abd Allah
Celestial Sphere . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 199
Ibn-Omar al Ghafiqi Ibn- . . . . . . . 133
Cervantes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133
al-Samh al-Mahri, Abu al-Qasim ’Asbagh ibn
Colure
Muhammad ibn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134
Almagest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Equinoctial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
altitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200 Solstitial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Andromeda Galaxy. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .247 Coordinate System
apparent magnitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 Ecliptical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
apparent radiant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Equatorial . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
ASCOM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 Galactic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Atmospheric Extinction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 231 Horizontal . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Atmospheric Refraction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 232 Copernicus, Nicolaus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
Augustus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 322 crossbow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210
azimuth . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
B
D
Barnard’s Star . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 214, 250
Bayer, Johann . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 DE430 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
binoculars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 247 DE431 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
Blazhko effect . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 275 declination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Bortle, John E. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 261 Deep-sky objects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30
Brahe, Tycho . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132, 203 double stars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 283
brown dwarfs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223 dwarf stars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
350 INDEX
E K
ecliptic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202, 203 Kopernik, Mikolaj . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
ecliptical latitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
ecliptical longitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 L
equator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
equinox . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Lipperhey, Hans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
luminosity class . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
F
M
FAQ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9, 332
First Point of Aries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202 M31 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229, 247
First Point of Cancer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203 Magellanic Cloud
First Point of Capricorn. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .203 Large . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228, 242
Flamsteed, John . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 219 Small . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228, 243
main sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
mathematical horizon . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
G Mayer, Johann Tobias . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 239
Mercator, Gerardus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
galactic latitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
meridian convergence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160
galactic longitude . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
Messier, Charles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Galilei, Galileo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
meteor shower . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
giants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
meteoroids . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
GPS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53
Milky Way . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 228
Miller, Osborn Maitland . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29
H Moore, Patrick . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 229
Halley, Edmund . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 227
Hammer, Ernst von . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 N
Handy Angles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210, 247
nadir . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Harriot, Thomas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132
NMEA . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Herschel, John . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205 Northern Ecliptical Pole . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
Hertzsprung, Ejnar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Hierarchical Progressive Surveys . . . . . . . . . 99
Hipparchus . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203, 210, 221
O
Hypatia . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132 obliquity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 203
obliquity of the ecliptic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211
I Opposition/Conjunction Line . . . . . . . . . . . 203
pulsars . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 204
R
radiant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141
Right ascension . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 202
Right Ascension/Declination . . . . . . . . . . . . 201
RTS2 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184
Russell, Henry Norris . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
S
scintillation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29, 232
sidereal time . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 205
sky survey . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99
spectral types . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
spectrum . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
super-giants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 222
T
time dragging . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
V
VSOP87 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
W
white dwarfs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 223
Z
zenith . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 200
Zenithal Hourly Rate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 142